]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blame - gcc/doc/tm.texi.in
linux-common.h (STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN): Define.
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi.in
CommitLineData
38f8b050 1@c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
ee3d2ecd 2@c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011, 2012
38f8b050
JR
3@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4@c This is part of the GCC manual.
5@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
6
7@node Target Macros
8@chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
9@cindex machine description macros
10@cindex target description macros
11@cindex macros, target description
12@cindex @file{tm.h} macros
13
14In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
15includes a C header file conventionally given the name
16@file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
17The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
18about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
19@file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
20@file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
21@file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
22source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
23containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
24machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
25if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
26through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
27
28@menu
29* Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
30* Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
31* Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
32* Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
33* Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
34* Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
35* Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36* Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37* Old Constraints:: The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
38* Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
39* Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
40* Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
41* Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
42* Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
43* Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
44* Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
45* Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
46* Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
47* Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
48* PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
49* Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
50* Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
51* Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
52* Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
53* Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
54* Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
55* MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
56* PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
57* C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
58* Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
59* Misc:: Everything else.
60@end menu
61
62@node Target Structure
63@section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
64@cindex target hooks
65@cindex target functions
66
67@deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
68The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
69which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
70machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
71@file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
72used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
73for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
74macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
75@smallexample
76#include "target.h"
77#include "target-def.h"
78
79/* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
80
81#undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
82#define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
83
84struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
85@end smallexample
86@end deftypevar
87
88Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
89form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
90``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
91from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
92@code{targetm} structure.
93
acce4e77
JM
94Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
95specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
96Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
dd5a833e 97initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
acce4e77
JM
98@file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
99themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
100@file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
101
c49a6962
JM
102Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
103are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
104documented as ``Common Target Hook''. This is declared in
105@file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
106@code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
107@file{common/common-target-def.h}. If targets initialize
108@code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
109@code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
110default definition is used.
111
38f8b050
JR
112@node Driver
113@section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
114@cindex driver
115@cindex controlling the compilation driver
116
117@c prevent bad page break with this line
118You can control the compilation driver.
119
38f8b050
JR
120@defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
121A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
122initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
123
124The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
125default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
126choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
127applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
128options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
129using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
130
131This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
132options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
133that the other specs are easier to write.
134
135Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
136@end defmac
137
138@defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
139A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
140@option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
141for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
142outermost pair of surrounding braces.
143
144The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
145the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
146to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
147@samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
148everywhere it occurs.
149
150The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
151default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
152the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
153
154Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
155@end defmac
156
157@defmac CPP_SPEC
158A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
159pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
160give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
161
162Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
163@end defmac
164
165@defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
166This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
167than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
168@code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
169@end defmac
170
171@defmac CC1_SPEC
172A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
173pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
174front ends.
175It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
176for GCC to pass to front ends.
177
178Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
179@end defmac
180
181@defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
182A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
183pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
184give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
185
186Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
187Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
188@code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
189CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
190@end defmac
191
192@defmac ASM_SPEC
193A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
194pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
195you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
196See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
197
198Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
199@end defmac
200
201@defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
202A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
203run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
204Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
205an example of this.
206
207Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
208@end defmac
209
210@defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
211Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
212an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
213read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
214output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
215@option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
216
217If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
218standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
219cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
220see @file{mips.h} for instance.
221@end defmac
222
223@defmac LINK_SPEC
224A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
225pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
226give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
227
228Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
229@end defmac
230
231@defmac LIB_SPEC
232Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
233between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
234command given to the linker.
235
236If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
237loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
238@end defmac
239
240@defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
241Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
242how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
243linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
244the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
245
246If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
247passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
248@end defmac
249
250@defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
251By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
252@code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
253instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
254depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
255@option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
256targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
257@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
258driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
259line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
260@end defmac
261
262@defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
263A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
264mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
265generated that uses --as-needed and the shared libgcc in place of the
266static exception handler library, when linking without any of
267@code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
268@end defmac
269
270@defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
271If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
272When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
273the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
274@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
275@end defmac
276
277@defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
278Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
279difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
280the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
281
282If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
283standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
284@end defmac
285
286@defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
287Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
288difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
289the very end of the command given to the linker.
290
291Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
292@end defmac
293
294@defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
295GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
296However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
297models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
298@code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
299blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
300default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
301@code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
302@end defmac
303
304@defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
305Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
306configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
307et al, within sysroot+suffix.
308@end defmac
309
310@defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
311Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
312GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
313updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
314usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
315@end defmac
316
317@defmac EXTRA_SPECS
318Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
319@file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
320@code{CC1_SPEC}.
321
322The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
323containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
324string constant that provides the specification.
325
326Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
327
328@code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
329related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
330to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
331these definitions.
332
333For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
334define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
335used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
336used.
337
338The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
339
340@smallexample
341#define EXTRA_SPECS \
342 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
343
344#define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
345@end smallexample
346
347The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
348@smallexample
349#undef CPP_SPEC
350#define CPP_SPEC \
351"%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
352%@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
353%@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
354%@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
355
356#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
357#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
358@end smallexample
359
360while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
361@code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
362
363@smallexample
364#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
365#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
366@end smallexample
367@end defmac
368
369@defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
370Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
371@file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
372the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
373@end defmac
374
375@defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
376The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
377By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
378@end defmac
379
380@defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
381A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
382linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
383change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
384define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
385line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
386the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
387@code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
388@end defmac
389
c49a6962
JM
390@hook TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
391
38f8b050
JR
392@defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
393Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
394string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
395target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
396@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
397
398Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
399the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
400@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
401@xref{Target Fragment}.
402@end defmac
403
404@defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
405Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
406a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
407indicates an absolute file name.
408@end defmac
409
410@defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
411If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
412@code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
413when the compiler is built as a cross
414compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
415to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
416@end defmac
417
418@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
419Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
420standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
421try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
422@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
423is built as a cross compiler.
424@end defmac
425
426@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
427Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
428standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
429when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
430@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
431is built as a cross compiler.
432@end defmac
433
434@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
435Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
436standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
437default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
438@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
439is built as a cross compiler.
440@end defmac
441
442@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
443If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
444standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
445compiler is built as a cross compiler.
446@end defmac
447
448@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
449If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
450standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
451cross compiler.
452@end defmac
453
454@defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
455Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
456variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
457loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
458initialize the necessary environment variables.
459@end defmac
460
461@defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
462Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
463standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
464try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
08b2bad2
SB
465comes before @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR} (set in
466@file{config.gcc}, normally @file{/usr/include}) in the search order.
38f8b050
JR
467
468Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
469replacement.
470@end defmac
471
08b2bad2
SB
472@defmac NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_COMPONENT
473The ``component'' corresponding to @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.
38f8b050
JR
474See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
475If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
476@end defmac
477
478@defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
479Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
480for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
481usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
08b2bad2
SB
482@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
483@code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
38f8b050
JR
484and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
485and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
486@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
487
488The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
489Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
490string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
491for C++-only directories,
492and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
493wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
494the array with a null element.
495
496The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
497if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
498or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
499operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
500
501For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
502
503@smallexample
504#define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
505@{ \
506 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
507 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
508 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
509 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
510 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
511@}
512@end smallexample
513@end defmac
514
515Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
516
517@enumerate
518@item
519Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
520
521@item
522The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
ff2ce160 523is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
38f8b050
JR
524@var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
525
526@item
527The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
528
529@item
530The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
ff2ce160 531in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
38f8b050
JR
532
533@item
ff2ce160 534The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
38f8b050
JR
535
536@item
ff2ce160 537The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
38f8b050
JR
538
539@item
ff2ce160 540The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
38f8b050
JR
541compiler.
542@end enumerate
543
544Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
545
546@enumerate
547@item
548Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
549
550@item
551The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
552value based on the installed toolchain location.
553
554@item
555The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
556(or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
557
558@item
559The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
ff2ce160 560in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
38f8b050
JR
561
562@item
563The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
564
565@item
ff2ce160 566The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
38f8b050
JR
567compiler.
568
569@item
ff2ce160 570The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
38f8b050
JR
571native compiler, or we have a target system root.
572
573@item
ff2ce160 574The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
38f8b050
JR
575native compiler, or we have a target system root.
576
577@item
578The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
579If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
580the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
581
582@item
583The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
584compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
585@file{/lib/}.
586
587@item
588The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
589compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
590@file{/usr/lib/}.
591@end enumerate
592
593@node Run-time Target
594@section Run-time Target Specification
595@cindex run-time target specification
596@cindex predefined macros
597@cindex target specifications
598
599@c prevent bad page break with this line
600Here are run-time target specifications.
601
602@defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
603This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
604built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
605the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
606@code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
607calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
608finished command line option processing your code can use those
609results freely.
610
611@code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
612command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
613the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
614accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
615
616@code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
617object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
618@code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
619defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
620with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
621only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
622example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
623and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
624@code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
625defines only @code{_ABI64}.
626
627You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
628@code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
629or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
630assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
631macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
632to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
633variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
634@code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
635preprocessing.
636@end defmac
637
638@defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
639Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
640and is used for the target operating system instead.
641@end defmac
642
643@defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
644Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
645and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
646macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
647it yourself.
648@end defmac
649
650@deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
651This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
652any target-specific headers.
653@end deftypevar
654
655@hook TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
656This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
657Its default setting is 0.
658@end deftypevr
659
660@cindex optional hardware or system features
661@cindex features, optional, in system conventions
662
663@hook TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION
664This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
665target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
666(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
667processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
668definition does nothing but return true.
669
96e45421
JM
670@var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
671@var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
672storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
673option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
674via attributes).
38f8b050
JR
675@end deftypefn
676
677@hook TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION
678This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
679target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
680definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
681option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
682valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
683default definition does nothing but return false.
684
685In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
686options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
687only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
688should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
689@end deftypefn
690
91ebb981
IS
691@hook TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT
692
70f42967
SB
693@hook TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_CLASS_REFERENCE
694
695@hook TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_CLASS_DEFINITION
696
91ebb981
IS
697@hook TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P
698
699@hook TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG
26705988 700
38f8b050
JR
701@hook TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE
702This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
703but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
704pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
705attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
706when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
707actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
708@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
709@end deftypefn
710
711@defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
c5387660
JM
712This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
713but is only used in the C
38f8b050
JR
714language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
715used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
716frontends.
717@end defmac
718
3020190e 719@hook TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
38f8b050 720Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
3020190e
JM
721various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
722options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
723options are processed once
38f8b050 724just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
3020190e 725of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
2b0d3573 726options passed explicitly.
38f8b050 727
3020190e 728This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
38f8b050
JR
729options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
730@code{optimize} attribute.
3020190e 731@end deftypevr
38f8b050 732
7e4aae92
JM
733@hook TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT
734
128dc8e2
JM
735@hook TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS
736
3bd36029
RS
737@defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
738Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
739during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
740the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
741can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
742and @code{nomips16} attributes.
743
744Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
745registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
746operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
747in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
748significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
749for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
750switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
751
752Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
753is 0.
754@end defmac
755
38f8b050
JR
756@node Per-Function Data
757@section Defining data structures for per-function information.
758@cindex per-function data
759@cindex data structures
760
761If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
762provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
763using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
764nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
765when another one comes along.
766
767GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
768contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
769structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
770@code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
771to their own specific data.
772
773If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
774@code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
775This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
776@code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
777
778One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
779RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
780RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
781function, for level 0.
782
783Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
784all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
785function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
786stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
787stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
788@code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
789the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
790single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
791longer supported.
792
793@defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
794Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
795is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
796The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
797function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
798@end defmac
799
800@deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
801If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
802function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
803target to perform any target specific initialization of the
804@code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
805used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
806
807@code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
808Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
809GC allocation, including the structure itself.
810@end deftypevar
811
812@node Storage Layout
813@section Storage Layout
814@cindex storage layout
815
816Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
817alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
818expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
819@xref{Run-time Target}.
820
821@defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
822Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
823byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
824This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
825bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
826be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
827macro need not be a constant.
828
829This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
830bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
831@end defmac
832
833@defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
834Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
835word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
836@end defmac
837
838@defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
839Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
840most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
c0a6a1ef
BS
841memory locations and registers; see @code{REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} if the
842order of words in memory is not the same as the order in registers. This
38f8b050
JR
843macro need not be a constant.
844@end defmac
845
c0a6a1ef
BS
846@defmac REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
847On some machines, the order of words in a multiword object differs between
848registers in memory. In such a situation, define this macro to describe
849the order of words in a register. The macro @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} controls
850the order of words in memory.
851@end defmac
852
38f8b050
JR
853@defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
854Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
855@code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
856containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
857have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
858
859You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
860multi-word integers.
861@end defmac
862
863@defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
864Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
865unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
866@end defmac
867
868@defmac BITS_PER_WORD
869Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
870is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
871@end defmac
872
873@defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
874Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
875@code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
876largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
877@end defmac
878
879@defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
880Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
881register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
882@end defmac
883
884@defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
885Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
886@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
887smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
888@end defmac
889
38f8b050
JR
890@defmac POINTER_SIZE
891Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
892width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
893you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
894a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
895@end defmac
896
897@defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
898A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
899@code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
900greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
901should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
902is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
903@code{ptr_extend} instruction.
904
905You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
906and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
907@end defmac
908
909@defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
910A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
911is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
912stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
913scalar type.
914
915On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
916register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
917@var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
918cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
919floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
920counterparts.
921
922For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
923However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
924either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
925the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
926sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
927@var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
928
929Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
930@end defmac
931
932@hook TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE
933Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
934function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
935and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
936change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
937pointer} types.
938
939@var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
940return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
941@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
942If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
943which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
944then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
945the signedness may be different.
946
5e617be8
AK
947@var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
948
38f8b050
JR
949The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
950also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
951if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
952@end deftypefn
953
954@defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
955Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
956bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
957regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
958size of an integer.
959@end defmac
960
961@defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
962Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
963stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
964desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
965if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
966this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
967@end defmac
968
969@defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
970Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
971stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
972is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
973macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
974@code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
975@end defmac
976
977@defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
978Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
979from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
980to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
981@end defmac
982
983@defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
984Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
985@end defmac
986
987@defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
988Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
989bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
990just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
991@end defmac
992
993@defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
994Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
995provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
996@end defmac
997
998@defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
999Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1000not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1001@end defmac
1002
1003@defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1004If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1005object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1006nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1007on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1008@end defmac
1009
1010@defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1011Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1012machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1013structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1014by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1015@end defmac
1016
1017@defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1018An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1019alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1020@code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1021alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1022field alignment has not been set by the
1023@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1024@end defmac
1025
1026@defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1027Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1028to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1029
1030If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1031
1032@c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1033@c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1034@c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1035@c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1036@end defmac
1037
1038@defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1039Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1040Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1041@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1042the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1043
1044On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1045the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1046a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((unsigned HOST_WIDEST_INT) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1047On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1048@samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1049@end defmac
1050
1051@defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1052If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1053the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1054the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1055macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1056
1057If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1058
1059@findex strcpy
1060One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1061make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1062arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1063constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1064@end defmac
1065
1066@defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1067If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1068that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1069@var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1070have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1071align the object.
1072
1073If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1074
1075The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1076constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1077constants can be done inline.
1078@end defmac
1079
1080@defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1081If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1082the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1083the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1084macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1085
1086If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1087
1088One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1089make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
4a6336ad 1090
64ad7c99 1091If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
38f8b050
JR
1092@end defmac
1093
5aea1e76
UW
1094@hook TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT
1095
38f8b050
JR
1096@defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1097If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1098@var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1099and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1100have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1101align the slot.
1102
1103If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1104@var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1105be used.
1106
1107This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1108of all possible modes which the slot may have.
4a6336ad 1109
64ad7c99 1110If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
38f8b050
JR
1111@end defmac
1112
1113@defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1114If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1115variable @var{decl}.
1116
1117If this macro is not defined, then
1118@code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1119is used.
1120
1121One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1122make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
4a6336ad 1123
64ad7c99 1124If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
38f8b050
JR
1125@end defmac
1126
1127@defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1128If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1129for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1130@var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1131
1132If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1133@end defmac
1134
1135@defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1136Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1137empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1138
1139If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1140@end defmac
1141
1142@defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1143Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1144Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1145
1146If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1147@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1148@end defmac
1149
1150@defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1151Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1152if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1153go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1154@end defmac
1155
1156@defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1157Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1158alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1159
1160The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1161@code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1162structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1163that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1164that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1165
1166Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1167@code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1168four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1169not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1170
1171An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1172structure.
1173
1174If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1175a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1176
1177Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1178bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1179support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1180@samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1181
1182The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1183@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1184Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1185
1186Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1187@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1188@code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1189
1190If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1191bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1192what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1193
1194@smallexample
1195struct foo1
1196@{
1197 char x;
1198 char :0;
1199 char y;
1200@};
1201
1202struct foo2
1203@{
1204 char x;
1205 int :0;
1206 char y;
1207@};
1208
1209main ()
1210@{
1211 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1212 sizeof (struct foo1));
1213 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1214 sizeof (struct foo2));
1215 exit (0);
1216@}
1217@end smallexample
1218
1219If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1220get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1221@end defmac
1222
1223@defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1224Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1225to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1226@end defmac
1227
1228@hook TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD
1229When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1230whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1231structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1232the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1233@end deftypefn
1234
1235@hook TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD
1236This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1237should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1238these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1239
1240The default is @code{!TARGET_STRICT_ALIGN}.
1241@end deftypefn
1242
d9886a9e
L
1243@hook TARGET_MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK
1244Return true if a structure, union or array containing @var{field} should
1245be accessed using @code{BLKMODE}.
38f8b050
JR
1246
1247If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1248mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1249case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1250retain the field's mode.
1251
1252Normally, this is not needed.
d9886a9e 1253@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
1254
1255@defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1256Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1257by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1258way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1259@var{specified}.
1260
1261The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1262the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1263@end defmac
1264
1265@defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1266An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1267machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1268this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1269appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1270(DImode)} is assumed.
1271@end defmac
1272
1273@defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1274If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1275specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1276@code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1277@var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1278@code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1279having its mode specified.
1280
1281You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1282would most commonly define this macro if the
1283@code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
128464-bit mode.
1285@end defmac
1286
1287@defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1288If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1289specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1290@code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1291
1292You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1293You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1294pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1295@end defmac
1296
1297@hook TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE
1298This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1299of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1300@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1301targets.
1302@end deftypefn
1303
1304@hook TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE
1305This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1306of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1307@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1308targets.
1309@end deftypefn
1310
1311@hook TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE
1312Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1313The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1314@end deftypefn
1315
1316@defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1317If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1318mode is towards zero.
1319
1320Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1321floating-point arithmetic.
1322
1323Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1324@end defmac
1325
1326@defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1327This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1328bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1329exponent for normal numbers instead.
1330
1331Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1332floating-point arithmetic.
1333
1334The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1335@end defmac
1336
1337@hook TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P
1338This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1339@var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1340Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1341unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1342different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1343alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1344bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1345the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1346(iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1347another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1348other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1349
1350When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1351of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1352bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1353and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1354chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1355size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1356alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1357
1358If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1359the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1360used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1361precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1362may affect its placement.
1363@end deftypefn
1364
1365@hook TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P
1366Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1367@end deftypefn
1368
1369@hook TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P
1370Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1371@end deftypefn
1372
1373@hook TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK
1374This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1375to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1376For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1377for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1378registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1379usage.
1380@end deftypefn
1381
1382@hook TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS
1383This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1384that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1385@end deftypefn
1386
1387@hook TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE
1388If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1389uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1390to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1391mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1392the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1393not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1394for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1395return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1396string constant.
1397
1398Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1399qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1400fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1401is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1402length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1403ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1404@var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1405@var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1406code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1407@code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1408codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1409spaces in your string.
1410
1411This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1412name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1413can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1414before mangling.
1415
1416The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1417appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1418types.
1419@end deftypefn
1420
1421@node Type Layout
1422@section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1423
1424These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1425basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1426the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1427languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1428
1429@defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1430A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1431target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1432@end defmac
1433
1434@defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1435A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1436target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1437(If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1438unit.)
1439@end defmac
1440
1441@defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1442A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1443target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1444@end defmac
1445
1446@defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1447On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1448@code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1449that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1450the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1451value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1452@end defmac
1453
1454@defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1455A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1456target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1457words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1458macro must be at least 64.
1459@end defmac
1460
1461@defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1462A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1463target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1464@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1465@end defmac
1466
1467@defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1468A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1469C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1470this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1471@end defmac
1472
1473@defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1474A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1475target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1476@end defmac
1477
1478@defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1479A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1480target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1481words.
1482@end defmac
1483
1484@defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1485A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1486the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1487words.
1488@end defmac
1489
1490@defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1491A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1492the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1493@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1494@end defmac
1495
1496@defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1497A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1498the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1499@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1500@end defmac
1501
1502@defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1503A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1504the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1505@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1506@end defmac
1507
1508@defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1509A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1510the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1511@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1512@end defmac
1513
1514@defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1515A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1516the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1517@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1518@end defmac
1519
1520@defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1521A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1522the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1523@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1524@end defmac
1525
1526@defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1527A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1528the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1529@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1530@end defmac
1531
1532@defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1533A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1534the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1535@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1536@end defmac
1537
1538@defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1539Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1540if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1541@code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. If you don't define this, the
1542default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1543@end defmac
1544
1545@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
a18bdccd 1546Define this macro if neither @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
38f8b050
JR
1547@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1548@code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
a18bdccd 1549anyway. If you don't define this and either @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
38f8b050
JR
1550or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1551otherwise it is 0.
1552@end defmac
1553
1554@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
1555Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1556@code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1557anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1558is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1559@end defmac
1560
1561@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
1562Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1563@code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1564anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1565is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1566@end defmac
1567
cdbf4541
BS
1568@defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1569This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1570hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It
1571causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1572prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which
1573uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1574the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1575@end defmac
1576
38f8b050
JR
1577@defmac SF_SIZE
1578@defmacx DF_SIZE
1579@defmacx XF_SIZE
1580@defmacx TF_SIZE
1581Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1582@code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1583if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate. By default,
1584@code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1585for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1586@code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
a18bdccd 1587@code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
38f8b050
JR
1588@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1589@end defmac
1590
1591@defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1592A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1593assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1594default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1595@code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1596@end defmac
1597
1598@defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1599A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1600supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1601value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1602If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1603is the default.
1604@end defmac
1605
1606@defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1607An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1608@code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1609always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1610and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1611@end defmac
1612
1613@hook TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1614This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1615@code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1616of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1617@code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1618
1619The default is to return false.
1620@end deftypefn
1621
1622@defmac SIZE_TYPE
1623A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1624for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1625contents of the string.
1626
1627The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1628spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1629appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1630of the data type names defined in the function
176a96de
HPN
1631@code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins} in the file @file{c-family/c-common.c}.
1632You may not omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the
1633compiler to crash on startup.
38f8b050
JR
1634
1635If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1636int"}.
1637@end defmac
1638
18dae016
TG
1639@defmac SIZETYPE
1640GCC defines internal types (@code{sizetype}, @code{ssizetype},
1641@code{bitsizetype} and @code{sbitsizetype}) for expressions
1642dealing with size. This macro is a C expression for a string describing
1643the name of the data type from which the precision of @code{sizetype}
1644is extracted.
1645
1646The string has the same restrictions as @code{SIZE_TYPE} string.
1647
1648If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{SIZE_TYPE}.
1649@end defmac
1650
38f8b050
JR
1651@defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1652A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1653for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1654@code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1655@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1656
1657If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1658@end defmac
1659
1660@defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1661A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1662for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1663the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1664information.
1665
1666If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1667@end defmac
1668
1669@defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1670A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1671characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1672@code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1673@end defmac
1674
1675@defmac WINT_TYPE
1676A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1677use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1678@code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1679contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1680information.
1681
1682If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1683@end defmac
1684
1685@defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1686A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1687can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1688The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1689string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1690
1691If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1692@code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1693much precision as @code{long long int}.
1694@end defmac
1695
1696@defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1697A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1698can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1699type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1700of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1701
1702If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1703@code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1704unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1705int}.
1706@end defmac
1707
1708@defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1709@defmacx INT8_TYPE
1710@defmacx INT16_TYPE
1711@defmacx INT32_TYPE
1712@defmacx INT64_TYPE
1713@defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1714@defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1715@defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1716@defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1717@defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1718@defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1719@defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1720@defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1721@defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1722@defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1723@defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1724@defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1725@defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1726@defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1727@defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1728@defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1729@defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1730@defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1731@defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1732@defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1733@defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1734@defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1735C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1736@code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1737@code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1738@code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1739@code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1740@code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1741@code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1742@code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1743@code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1744@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1745
1746If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1747type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1748@code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1749to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1750these macros are null pointers.
1751@end defmac
1752
1753@defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1754The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1755that looks like:
1756
1757@smallexample
1758 struct @{
1759 union @{
1760 void (*fn)();
1761 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1762 @};
1763 ptrdiff_t delta;
1764 @};
1765@end smallexample
1766
1767@noindent
1768The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1769will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1770Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1771always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1772distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1773platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1774that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1775the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1776
1777GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1778this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1779However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1780set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1781bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1782address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1783architecture, you should define this macro to
1784@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1785
1786In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1787in which function addresses are always even, according to
1788@code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1789@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1790@end defmac
1791
1792@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1793Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1794macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1795instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1796function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1797data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1798pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1799
1800If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1801of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1802@end defmac
1803
1804@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1805By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1806is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1807the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1808when special alignment is necessary. */
1809@end defmac
1810
1811@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1812There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1813zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1814specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1815of words in each data entry.
1816@end defmac
1817
1818@node Registers
1819@section Register Usage
1820@cindex register usage
1821
1822This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1823has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1824
1825The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1826done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1827on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1828For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1829For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1830
1831@menu
1832* Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1833* Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1834* Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1835* Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1836* Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1837@end menu
1838
1839@node Register Basics
1840@subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1841
1842@c prevent bad page break with this line
1843Registers have various characteristics.
1844
1845@defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1846Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1847numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1848pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1849@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1850@end defmac
1851
1852@defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1853@cindex fixed register
1854An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1855all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1856general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1857pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1858register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1859machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1860and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1861
1862This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1863commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1864register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1865
1866The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1867the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1868by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1869the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1870@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1871@end defmac
1872
1873@defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1874@cindex call-used register
1875@cindex call-clobbered register
1876@cindex call-saved register
1877Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1878clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1879registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1880available for general allocation of values that must live across
1881function calls.
1882
1883If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1884automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1885exit, if the register is used within the function.
1886@end defmac
1887
1888@defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1889@cindex call-used register
1890@cindex call-clobbered register
1891@cindex call-saved register
1892Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1893that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1894(@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1895This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1896of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1897@end defmac
1898
1899@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1900@cindex call-used register
1901@cindex call-clobbered register
1902@cindex call-saved register
1903A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1904value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1905call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1906macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1907preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1908@end defmac
1909
1910@findex fixed_regs
1911@findex call_used_regs
1912@findex global_regs
1913@findex reg_names
1914@findex reg_class_contents
5efd84c5
NF
1915@hook TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1916This hook may conditionally modify five variables
38f8b050
JR
1917@code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1918@code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1919any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1920of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1921@code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1922@code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1923called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1924@code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1925from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1926@code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1927@code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1928@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1929command options have been applied.
1930
38f8b050
JR
1931@cindex disabling certain registers
1932@cindex controlling register usage
1933If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1934flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1935@code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1936registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
1937the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
1938to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1939is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1940
1941(However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1942of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1943controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1944these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
5efd84c5 1945@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
1946
1947@defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1948Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1949expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1950corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1951function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1952outbound register.
1953@end defmac
1954
1955@defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1956Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1957expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1958corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1959function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1960register.
1961@end defmac
1962
1963@defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1964Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1965expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1966register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1967need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1968gotos.
1969@end defmac
1970
1971@defmac PC_REGNUM
1972If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1973register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
1974@end defmac
1975
1976@node Allocation Order
1977@subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1978@cindex order of register allocation
1979@cindex register allocation order
1980
1981@c prevent bad page break with this line
1982Registers are allocated in order.
1983
1984@defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1985If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1986numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1987to use them (from most preferred to least).
1988
1989If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1990(all else being equal).
1991
1992One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1993registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1994instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
1995machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
1996the highest numbered allocable register first.
1997@end defmac
1998
1999@defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2000A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
2001hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
2002
2003Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
2004Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
2005register; and so on.
2006
2007The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
2008@code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
2009
2010On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2011@end defmac
2012
2013@defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2014Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2015prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
2016using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2017allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2018call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, this macro
2019should be defined.
2020@end defmac
2021
2022@defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2023In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2024Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2025If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2026based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2027be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2028value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2029to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2030
2031On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2032@end defmac
2033
2034@node Values in Registers
2035@subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2036
2037This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2038(specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2039consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2040
2041@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2042A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2043at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2044@var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2045cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2046and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2047
2048On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2049definition of this macro is
2050
2051@smallexample
2052#define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2053 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2054 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2055@end smallexample
2056@end defmac
2057
2058@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2059A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2060in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2061in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2062multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2063this mode by the number of registers returned by
2064@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2065
2066For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2067registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2068nonzero.
2069
2070This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2071@code{subreg_get_info}
2072would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2073represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2074@code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2075registers and so not be representable.
2076@end defmac
2077
2078@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2079For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2080@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2081returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2082including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2083@end defmac
2084
2085@defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2086Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2087of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2088should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2089used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2090happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2091floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2092@end defmac
2093
2094@defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2095A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2096of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2097registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2098are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2099
2100@smallexample
2101#define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2102@end smallexample
2103
2104You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2105because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2106
2107@cindex register pairs
2108On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2109register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2110odd register numbers for such modes.
2111
2112The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2113@samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2114register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2115value into the register and back out not alter it.
2116
2117Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2118all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2119@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2120you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2121is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2122and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2123to be tieable.
2124
2125Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2126Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2127in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2128can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2129mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2130registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2131
2132On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2133modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2134registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2135non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2136@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2137floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2138normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2139unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2140register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2141
2142The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2143they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2144instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2145@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2146constraints for those instructions.
2147
2148On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2149so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2150register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2151floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2152be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2153@end defmac
2154
2155@defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2156A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2157@var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2158
2159One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2160another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2161handler.
2162
2163The default is always nonzero.
2164@end defmac
2165
2166@defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2167A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2168@var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2169
2170If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2171@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2172any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2173should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2174this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2175accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2176
2177You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2178possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2179allocation.
2180@end defmac
2181
2182@hook TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK
2183This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2184@var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2185
2186One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2187is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2188
2189The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2190@end deftypefn
2191
2192@defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2193Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2194registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2195@code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2196@end defmac
2197
2198@node Leaf Functions
2199@subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2200
2201@cindex leaf functions
2202@cindex functions, leaf
2203On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2204more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2205means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2206are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2207normally arrive.
2208
2209The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2210other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2211registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2212function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2213handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2214functions''.
2215
2216GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2217suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2218registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2219accomplish this.
2220
2221@defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2222Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2223contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2224function treatment.
2225
2226If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2227registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2228GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2229used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2230in this vector.
2231
2232Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2233the treatment of leaf functions.
2234@end defmac
2235
2236@defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2237A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2238should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2239
2240If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2241function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2242will cause the compiler to abort.
2243
2244Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2245treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2246this.
2247@end defmac
2248
2249@findex current_function_is_leaf
2250@findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2251@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2252@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2253specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2254which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2255set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2256compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2257@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2258functions which only use leaf registers.
2259@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2260that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2261@code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2262@c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2263@c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2264
2265@node Stack Registers
2266@subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2267
2268There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2269``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2270pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2271stack.
2272
2273Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2274they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2275support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2276point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2277stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2278@file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2279with it, as well as defining these macros.
2280
2281@defmac STACK_REGS
2282Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2283@end defmac
2284
2285@defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2286This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2287the machine has any stack-like registers.
2288@end defmac
2289
2290@defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2291The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2292of the stack.
2293@end defmac
2294
2295@defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2296The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2297the stack.
2298@end defmac
2299
2300@node Register Classes
2301@section Register Classes
2302@cindex register class definitions
2303@cindex class definitions, register
2304
2305On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2306For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2307certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2308restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2309
2310You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2311which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2312that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2313
2314@findex ALL_REGS
2315@findex NO_REGS
2316In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2317class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2318class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2319union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2320
2321@findex GENERAL_REGS
2322One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2323terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2324@samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2325the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2326to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2327
2328Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2329then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2330
2331The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2332constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2333You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2334them in operand constraints.
2335
6049a4c8
HPN
2336You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2337registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2338some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2339cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2340(@pxref{Costs}).
2341
38f8b050
JR
2342You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2343instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2344either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2345certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
b899fd78
JR
2346which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2347or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
dd5a833e 2348class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
38f8b050
JR
2349
2350You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2351classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2352contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2353in their union.
2354
2355When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2356certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2357Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2358a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2359specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2360
2361Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2362instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2363each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2364mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2365single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2366this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2367instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2368single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2369@code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2370
2371@deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2372An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2373as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2374must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2375@code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2376tells how many classes there are.
2377
2378Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2379the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2380in many of the tables described below.
2381@end deftp
2382
2383@defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2384The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2385
2386@smallexample
2387#define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2388@end smallexample
2389@end defmac
2390
2391@defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2392An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2393constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2394@end defmac
2395
2396@defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2397An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2398which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2399@var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2400register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2401
2402When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2403Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2404several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2405for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2406In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2407registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2408so on.
2409@end defmac
2410
2411@defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2412A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2413@var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2414which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2415register.
2416@end defmac
2417
2418@defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2419A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2420base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2421which is the register value plus a displacement.
2422@end defmac
2423
2424@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2425This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2426the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2427@var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2428@code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2429@end defmac
2430
2431@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2432A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2433base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2434register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2435addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2436@end defmac
2437
86fc3d06 2438@defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
38f8b050 2439A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
86fc3d06
UW
2440base register for a memory reference in mode @var{mode} to address
2441space @var{address_space} must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code}
2442define the context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is
2443the code of the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level
2444of an address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
38f8b050
JR
2445@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2446index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2447@end defmac
2448
2449@defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2450A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2451index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2452address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2453added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2454@end defmac
2455
2456@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2457A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2458suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
38f8b050
JR
2459@end defmac
2460
2461@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2462A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2463that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2464@var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2465reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2466you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2467@code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2468addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2469@code{address_operand}.
38f8b050
JR
2470@end defmac
2471
2472@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2473A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2474use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2475memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2476pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2477define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2478than other base register uses.
2479
2480Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2481@code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
38f8b050
JR
2482@end defmac
2483
86fc3d06
UW
2484@defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2485A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2486suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses, accessing
2487memory in mode @var{mode} in address space @var{address_space}.
2488This is similar to @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
38f8b050
JR
2489that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2490appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2491immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2492address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2493@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2494corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2495@code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2496that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
38f8b050
JR
2497@end defmac
2498
2499@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2500A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2501suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2502either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2503allocated such a hard register.
2504
2505The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2506the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2507two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2508labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2509labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2510may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2511looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2512only if neither labeling works.
38f8b050
JR
2513@end defmac
2514
5f286f4a
YQ
2515@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS
2516
fba42e24
AS
2517@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS
2518A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2519to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2520@var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2521another, smaller class.
2522
2523The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2524
2525Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2526example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2527for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2528@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2529Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2530
2531One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2532@var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2533loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2534force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2535immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2536instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2537register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2538@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2539into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
1a627b35 2540@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
fba42e24
AS
2541of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2542
2543If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2544through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2545to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2546reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2547this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2548the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2549@end deftypefn
2550
38f8b050
JR
2551@defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2552A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2553to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2554@var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2555another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2556safe:
2557
2558@smallexample
2559#define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2560@end smallexample
2561
2562Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2563example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2564for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2565@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2566Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2567
2568One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2569@var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2570loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2571force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2572immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2573instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2574register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2575@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2576into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
1a627b35
RS
2577@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2578of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
38f8b050
JR
2579
2580If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2581through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2582to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2583reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2584this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2585the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2586@end defmac
2587
abd26bfb
AS
2588@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2589Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2590input reloads.
2591
2592The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2593argument.
2594
2595You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2596reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2597@end deftypefn
2598
38f8b050
JR
2599@defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2600A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2601to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2602@var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2603ordinarily be used.
2604
2605Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2606there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2607
2608The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2609smaller class.
2610
2611Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2612require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2613@end defmac
2614
2615@hook TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD
2616Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2617from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2618@samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2619from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2620term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2621directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2622register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2623destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2624source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2625reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2626and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2627intermediate register still holds the required value.
2628
2629Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2630allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2631register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2632address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2633when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2634as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2635that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2636describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2637these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2638of the scratch register(s).
2639
2640In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2641
2642For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2643and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2644@var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2645hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2646needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2647
2648If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2649an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2650return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2651If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2652If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2653that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2654
2655If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2656perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2657closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2658required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2659copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2660
2661You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2662in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2663and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2664for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2665single-register-class
2666@c [later: or memory]
2667output constraint.
2668
2669When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2670hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2671register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2672have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2673
2674@c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2675@c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2676@c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2677@c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2678@c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2679@c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2680@c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2681@c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2682
2683
2684@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2685pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2686Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2687in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2688
2689Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2690currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2691to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2692
2693@code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2694copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2695(a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2696Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2697of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2698forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2699@end deftypefn
2700
2701@defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2702@defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2703@defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2704These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2705@code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2706
2707These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2708target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2709reload phase that it may
2710need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2711register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2712register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2713you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2714largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2715intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2716
2717If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2718intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2719was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2720class required. If the
2721requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2722@code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2723macros identically.
2724
2725The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2726Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2727can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2728@var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2729macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2730
2731If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2732intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2733@samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2734(@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2735implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2736@samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2737register.
2738
2739These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2740register that
2741contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2742class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2743value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2744register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2745Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2746
2747@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2748pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2749Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2750in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2751
2752These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2753registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2754registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2755would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2756the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2757intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2758general registers.
2759@end defmac
2760
2761@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2762Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2763to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2764those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2765@var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2766class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2767and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2768
2769Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2770@end defmac
2771
2772@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2773Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2774allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2775If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2776defined by this macro.
2777
2778Do not define this macro if you do not define
2779@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2780@end defmac
2781
2782@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2783When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2784registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2785hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2786load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2787same as that of @var{mode}.
2788
2789This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2790bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2791in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2792registers.
2793
2794However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2795the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2796differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2797widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2798suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2799details.
2800
2801Do not define this macro if you do not define
2802@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2803is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2804@end defmac
2805
07b8f0a8
AS
2806@hook TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P
2807A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2808to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2809registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2810
2811The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2812has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2813default should be used. Only use this target hook to some other expression
2814if pseudos allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their
2815hard registers were needed for spill registers. If this target hook returns
2816@code{false} for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2817@file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2818register. If there would not be another register available for reallocation,
2819you should not change the implementation of this target hook since
2820the only effect of such implementation would be to slow down register
2821allocation.
2822@end deftypefn
a8c44c52
AS
2823
2824@hook TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS
2825A target hook returns the maximum number of consecutive registers
2826of class @var{rclass} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2827
2828This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
1c7836f0 2829the value returned by @code{TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{rclass},
a8c44c52
AS
2830@var{mode})} target hook should be the maximum value of
2831@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})} for all @var{regno}
2832values in the class @var{rclass}.
2833
2834This target hook helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2835in the reload pass.
2836
2837The default version of this target hook returns the size of @var{mode}
2838in words.
2839@end deftypefn
07b8f0a8 2840
38f8b050
JR
2841@defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2842A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2843of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2844
2845This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2846the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2847should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2848@var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2849
2850This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2851in the reload pass.
2852@end defmac
2853
2854@defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2855If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2856a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2857
2858For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2859floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2860Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2861does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2862register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2863as below:
2864
2865@smallexample
2866#define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2867 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2868 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2869@end smallexample
2870@end defmac
2871
38f8b050
JR
2872@node Old Constraints
2873@section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2874@cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2875@cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2876
2877Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2878of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2879Constraints}. This mechanism is obsolete. New ports should not use
2880it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2881
2882@defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2883For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2884@var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2885constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2886you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2887constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2888DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2889to handle specially.
2890There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2891for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2892transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2893return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2894will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2895@end defmac
2896
2897@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2898A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2899letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2900value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2901the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2902corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2903to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2904@end defmac
2905
2906@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2907Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2908passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2909different variants.
2910@end defmac
2911
2912@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2913A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2914letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2915particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2916letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2917the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2918not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2919@var{value}.
2920@end defmac
2921
2922@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2923Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2924string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2925between different variants.
2926@end defmac
2927
2928@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2929A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2930letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2931(@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2932
2933If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2934@var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2935range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
2936letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2937
2938@code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2939@code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
2940or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2941between these kinds.
2942@end defmac
2943
2944@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2945Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2946string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2947between different variants.
2948@end defmac
2949
2950@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2951A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2952letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2953memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
2954elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
2955@code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
2956may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
2957
2958If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2959if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
2960constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
2961constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2962
2963For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
2964in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
2965letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
2966@emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
2967a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
2968alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
2969does not include r0 on the output.
2970@end defmac
2971
2972@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2973Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
2974in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
2975variants.
2976@end defmac
2977
2978@defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2979A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2980letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
2981be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
2982
2983It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2984at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
2985comprises a subset of all memory references including
2986all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
2987pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2988type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
2989
2990For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
2991memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
2992register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
2993@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
2994If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
2995a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
2996reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
2997into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
2998an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
2999@end defmac
3000
3001@defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
3002A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3003letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
3004@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
3005be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
3006
3007It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3008at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
3009a subset of all memory addresses including
3010all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
3011pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3012type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
3013
3014Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
3015be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
3016analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
3017@end defmac
3018
3019@node Stack and Calling
3020@section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
3021@cindex calling conventions
3022
3023@c prevent bad page break with this line
3024This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
3025
3026@menu
3027* Frame Layout::
3028* Exception Handling::
3029* Stack Checking::
3030* Frame Registers::
3031* Elimination::
3032* Stack Arguments::
3033* Register Arguments::
3034* Scalar Return::
3035* Aggregate Return::
3036* Caller Saves::
3037* Function Entry::
3038* Profiling::
3039* Tail Calls::
3040* Stack Smashing Protection::
3041@end menu
3042
3043@node Frame Layout
3044@subsection Basic Stack Layout
3045@cindex stack frame layout
3046@cindex frame layout
3047
3048@c prevent bad page break with this line
3049Here is the basic stack layout.
3050
3051@defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3052Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3053pointer to a smaller address.
3054
3055When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
3056compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
3057definition used does not matter.
3058@end defmac
3059
3060@defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
3061This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3062on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
3063@code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
3064
3065The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3066and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
3067the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3068to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3069space for the next item on the stack.
3070
3071The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3072defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3073which is often wrong.
3074@end defmac
3075
3076@defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3077Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
3078are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
3079@end defmac
3080
3081@defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
3082Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3083addresses on the stack.
3084@end defmac
3085
3086@defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
3087Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
3088
3089If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
3090subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3091Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
3092value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3093@c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
3094@c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
3095@end defmac
3096
3097@defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
3098Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3099The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3100
3101On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3102is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3103alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3104stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3105@end defmac
3106
3107@defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3108Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3109outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3110zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3111
3112If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3113the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3114@end defmac
3115
3116@defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3117Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3118address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3119function.
3120
3121If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3122the first argument's address.
3123@end defmac
3124
3125@defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3126Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3127on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3128
3129The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3130length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3131machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3132@end defmac
3133
3134@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3135A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3136stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3137@code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3138default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3139elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3140@code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3141@end defmac
3142
3143@defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3144A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3145frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3146@var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3147itself.
3148
3149If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3150of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3151address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3152@end defmac
3153
3154@defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3155If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3156setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3157on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3158before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3159define this macro.
3160@end defmac
3161
3162@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
3163This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3164the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3165The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3166machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3167@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3168@end deftypefn
3169
3170@defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3171A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3172address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3173of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3174You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3175as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3176@end defmac
3177
3178@defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3179A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3180address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3181the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3182frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3183@code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3184
3185The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3186@var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3187determine the return address of other frames.
3188@end defmac
3189
3190@defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3191Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3192from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
3193@end defmac
3194
3195@defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3196A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3197incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3198prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3199value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3200the stack.
3201
3202You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3203debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3204
3205If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3206@code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3207@end defmac
3208
3209@defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3210A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3211number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3212must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3213be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3214
3215This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3216general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3217frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3218over time.
3219@end defmac
3220
3221@defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3222A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3223number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3224only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3225someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3226terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3227@end defmac
3228
3229@hook TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC
3230This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3231contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3232info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3233@smallexample
3234(set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3235@end smallexample
3236and
3237@smallexample
3238(set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3239@end smallexample
3240to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3241the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3242the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3243@end deftypefn
3244
3245@defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3246A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3247from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3248frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3249the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3250previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3251
3252You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3253debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3254@end defmac
3255
3256@defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3257A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3258from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3259final value should coincide with that calculated by
3260@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3261during virtual register instantiation.
3262
3263The default value for this macro is
3264@code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3265which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3266immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3267some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3268and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3269
3270You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3271want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3272DWARF 2.
3273@end defmac
3274
3275@defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3276If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3277in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3278The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3279@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3280
3281Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3282via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3283variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3284defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3285based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3286of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3287should be defined.
3288@end defmac
3289
3290@defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3291If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3292in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3293in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3294may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3295@end defmac
3296
3297@node Exception Handling
3298@subsection Exception Handling Support
3299@cindex exception handling
3300
3301@defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3302A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3303data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3304@var{N} registers are usable.
3305
3306The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3307handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3308should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3309but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
33102 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3311
3312You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3313handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3314@end defmac
3315
3316@defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3317A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3318to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3319This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3320It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3321
3322Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3323untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3324
3325Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3326by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3327this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3328stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3329this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3330that provided by DWARF 2.
3331@end defmac
3332
3333@defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3334A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3335to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3336return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3337
3338Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3339return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3340address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3341the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3342frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3343been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3344target call frame.
3345
3346Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3347address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3348the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3349
3350If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3351define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3352@end defmac
3353
3354@defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3355If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3356to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3357exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3358using it to return to the exception handler.
3359@end defmac
3360
3361@defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3362This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3363handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3364that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3365and so may be read-only.
3366
3367@var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3368@var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3369The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3370as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3371
3372If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3373represented directly.
3374@end defmac
3375
3376@defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3377This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3378to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3379Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3380be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3381
3382This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3383handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3384of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3385to be emitted.
3386@end defmac
3387
38f8b050
JR
3388@defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3389This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3390code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3391available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3392through signal frames.
3393
3394This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3395@file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3396@file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3397@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3398for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3399the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3400save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3401evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3402the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3403
3404For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3405@code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3406@end defmac
3407
3408@defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3409This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3410call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3411usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3412
0c93ed52
SB
3413This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in libgcc's
3414@file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
38f8b050
JR
3415@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3416for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3417@code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3418be updated in @var{fs}.
3419@end defmac
3420
3421@defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3422A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3423info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3424linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3425@end defmac
3426
3427@node Stack Checking
3428@subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3429
3430GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3431stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3432three ways:
3433
3434@enumerate
3435@item
3436If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3437will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3438at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3439other special processing.
3440
3441@item
3442If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3443@code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3444that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3445static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3446in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3447stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3448approach below.
3449
3450@item
3451If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3452``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3453@end enumerate
3454
3455If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3456GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3457@option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3458dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3459
3460@defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3461A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3462machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3463is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3464checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3465value of this macro is zero.
3466@end defmac
3467
3468@defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3469A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3470in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3471like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3472approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3473@end defmac
3474
3475@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3476An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3477instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3478define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3479the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3480of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3481@end defmac
3482
3483@defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3484An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3485when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3486contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3487thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3488is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3489default value of this macro is zero.
3490@end defmac
3491
3492@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3493The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3494languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3495with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
34968192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3497most machines.
3498@end defmac
3499
3500The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3501nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3502in the opposite case.
3503
3504@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3505The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3506instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3507stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3508checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3509default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3510systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3511@end defmac
3512
3513@defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3514GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3515represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3516space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3517You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3518use the default of four words.
3519@end defmac
3520
3521@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3522The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3523fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3524@option{-fstack-check}.
3525GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3526normally not need to override that default.
3527@end defmac
3528
3529@need 2000
3530@node Frame Registers
3531@subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3532
3533@c prevent bad page break with this line
3534This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3535
3536@defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3537The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3538fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3539the hardware determines which register this is.
3540@end defmac
3541
3542@defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3543The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3544access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3545hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3546choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3547@end defmac
3548
3549@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3550On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3551offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3552allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3553between these two locations). On those machines, define
3554@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3555be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3556@code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3557used for the frame pointer.
3558
3559You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3560is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3561the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3562completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3563definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3564@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3565or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3566
3567Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3568@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3569@end defmac
3570
3571@defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3572The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3573the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3574frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3575register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3576wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3577pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3578@code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3579(@pxref{Elimination}).
3580@end defmac
3581
e3339d0f
JM
3582@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3583Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3584@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3585the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3586== FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3587definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3588@end defmac
3589
3590@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3591Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3592@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3593same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3594ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3595definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3596@end defmac
3597
38f8b050
JR
3598@defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3599The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3600access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3601machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3602pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3603to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3604@code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3605
3606Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3607address from the stack.
3608@end defmac
3609
3610@defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3611@defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3612Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3613register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3614function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3615number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3616these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3617not be defined.
3618
3619The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3620
3621If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3622defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3623@end defmac
3624
3625@hook TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN
3626This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3627targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3628nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3629attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3630those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3631
3632The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3633
3634If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3635provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3636Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3637from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3638will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3639@findex stack_pointer_rtx
3640@findex frame_pointer_rtx
3641@findex arg_pointer_rtx
3642The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3643@code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3644to refer to those items.
3645@end deftypefn
3646
3647@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3648This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3649saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3650DWARF2 exception handling.
3651
3652Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3653exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3654extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3655in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3656used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3657routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3658registers that are not call-saved.
3659
3660If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3661@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3662@end defmac
3663
3664@defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3665
3666This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3667for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3668
3669If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3670@code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3671@end defmac
3672
3673@defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3674
3675Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3676is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3677Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3678column number to use instead.
3679
3680See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3681@end defmac
3682
3683@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3684
3685Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3686used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3687debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3688should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3689@code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3690
3691@end defmac
3692
3693@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3694
3695Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3696that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3697should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3698.eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3699return @code{@var{regno}}.
3700
3701@end defmac
3702
cca2207a
L
3703@defmac REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3704
3705Define this macro if the target stores register values as
3706@code{_Unwind_Word} type in unwind context. It should be defined if
3707target register size is larger than the size of @code{void *}. The
3708default is to store register values as @code{void *} type.
3709
3710@end defmac
3711
3712@defmac ASSUME_EXTENDED_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3713
3714Define this macro to be 1 if the target always uses extended unwind
3715context with version, args_size and by_value fields. If it is undefined,
3716it will be defined to 1 when @code{REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT} is
3717defined and 0 otherwise.
3718
3719@end defmac
3720
38f8b050
JR
3721@node Elimination
3722@subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3723
3724@c prevent bad page break with this line
3725This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3726
3727@hook TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3728This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3729a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3730value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3731
3732This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3733according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3734constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3735to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3736Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3737pointer.
3738
3739In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3740without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3741automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3742@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
3743them.
3744
3745In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3746register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3747fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3748
3749Default return value is @code{false}.
3750@end deftypefn
3751
3752@findex get_frame_size
3753@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3754A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3755between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3756the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3757such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3758registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3759
3760If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3761need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3762@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3763case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3764@end defmac
3765
3766@defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3767If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3768eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3769defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3770references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3771
3772The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3773of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3774
3775On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3776the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3777must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3778replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3779depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3780
3781In this case, you might specify:
3782@smallexample
3783#define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3784@{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3785 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3786 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3787@end smallexample
3788
3789Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3790specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3791@end defmac
3792
3793@hook TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE
3794This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3795try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3796@var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3797is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
3798preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3799knows about.
3800
3801Default return value is @code{true}.
3802@end deftypefn
3803
3804@defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3805This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3806specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3807registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3808defined.
3809@end defmac
3810
3811@node Stack Arguments
3812@subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3813@cindex arguments on stack
3814@cindex stack arguments
3815
3816The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3817on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3818control passing certain arguments in registers.
3819
3820@hook TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3821This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3822prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3823passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3824cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3825The default is to not promote prototypes.
3826@end deftypefn
3827
3828@defmac PUSH_ARGS
3829A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3830outgoing arguments.
3831If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3832That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3833allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3834it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3835@end defmac
3836
3837@defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3838A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3839last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3840defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3841and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3842@end defmac
3843
3844@defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3845A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3846stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3847
3848On some machines, the definition
3849
3850@smallexample
3851#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3852@end smallexample
3853
3854@noindent
3855will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3856to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3857alignment. Then the definition should be
3858
3859@smallexample
3860#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3861@end smallexample
4a6336ad 3862
64ad7c99 3863If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
38f8b050
JR
3864@end defmac
3865
29454ff5
SL
3866@findex outgoing_args_size
3867@findex crtl->outgoing_args_size
38f8b050
JR
3868@defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3869A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
29454ff5
SL
3870will be computed and placed into
3871@code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
38f8b050
JR
3872onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3873increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3874
3875Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3876is not proper.
3877@end defmac
3878
3879@defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3880Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3881allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3882registers.
3883
3884The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3885arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3886which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3887The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3888of the function.
3889
3890This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3891machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3892which.
3893@end defmac
3894@c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3895@c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3896
3897@defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3898Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3899caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3900when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3901if the function called is a library function.
3902
3903If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3904whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
29454ff5 3905@code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}.
38f8b050
JR
3906@end defmac
3907
3908@defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3909Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3910stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3911@c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3912@c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3913
3914Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3915stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3916suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3917stack in its natural location.
3918@end defmac
3919
893d13d5 3920@hook TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS
38f8b050
JR
3921This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3922a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3923and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3924
3925@var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3926the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3927@code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3928From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3929
3930@var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3931describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3932@code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3933From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3934arguments (if known).
3935
3936When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3937will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3938you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3939by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3940a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3941in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3942
893d13d5 3943@var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
38f8b050
JR
3944stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3945argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3946
3947On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
893d13d5 3948of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
38f8b050
JR
3949calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3950the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3951convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3952arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3953nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3954@var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3955number of arguments.
3956@end deftypefn
3957
3958@defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3959A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3960pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3961when compiling a function call.
3962
3963@var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3964have been accumulated.
3965
3966On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3967that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3968that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3969call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3970appropriate.
3971@end defmac
3972
3973@node Register Arguments
3974@subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3975@cindex arguments in registers
3976@cindex registers arguments
3977
3978This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3979types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3980the stack.
3981
b25b9e8f
NF
3982@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG
3983Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
3984register and if so, which register.
38f8b050 3985
b25b9e8f 3986The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
38f8b050
JR
3987arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3988the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3989(which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
b25b9e8f
NF
3990which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
3991nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
3992function's prototype. @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
3993syntax error has previously occurred.
38f8b050 3994
b25b9e8f
NF
3995The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3996register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
3997on the stack.
38f8b050
JR
3998
3999The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
4000used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
4001@code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
4002@code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
4003describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
4004@code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
4005register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
4006register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
4007second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
4008the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
4009As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
4010RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
4011argument is also stored on the stack.
4012
b25b9e8f 4013The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
38f8b050
JR
4014VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
4015pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
4016
4017@cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
b25b9e8f
NF
4018The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
4019machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
4020cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is
4021done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
4022@var{named} is @code{false}.
4023
4024@cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
4025@cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
38f8b050
JR
4026You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
4027in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
4028type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
b25b9e8f 4029is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
38f8b050
JR
4030argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
4031defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
4032a register.
b25b9e8f 4033@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
4034
4035@hook TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
4036This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
4037solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
4038definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
4039documentation.
4040@end deftypefn
4041
b25b9e8f
NF
4042@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG
4043Define this hook if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
38f8b050
JR
4044that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
4045necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
4046argument.
4047
b25b9e8f
NF
4048For such machines, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
4049which the caller passes the value, and
4050@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
4051fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
4052arrive.
38f8b050 4053
b25b9e8f
NF
4054If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
4055@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
4056@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
4057
4058@hook TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES
4059This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4060argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
4061arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4062pushed on the stack.
4063
4064On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4065registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
4066first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4067on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4068structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4069in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
4070compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4071
b25b9e8f 4072@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
38f8b050 4073register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
b25b9e8f 4074@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
38f8b050
JR
4075@end deftypefn
4076
ec9f85e5 4077@hook TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
38f8b050
JR
4078This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
4079position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
4080predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4081passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4082
4083If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4084pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4085The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4086to that type.
4087@end deftypefn
4088
4089@hook TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES
4090The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4091known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4092function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4093by the caller.
4094
4095For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4096determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4097not be generated.
4098
4099The default version of this hook always returns false.
4100@end deftypefn
4101
4102@defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
b25b9e8f
NF
4103A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
4104of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
4105target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
4106of bytes of argument so far.
38f8b050
JR
4107
4108There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4109arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4110variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4111arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4112@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4113should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4114@end defmac
4115
4116@defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4117If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4118function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4119created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4120reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4121If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4122@var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4123@end defmac
4124
4125@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4126A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4127@var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4128variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4129is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4130the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4131For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4132declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4133@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4134being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4135arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4136parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4137@var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4138
4139When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4140@var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4141contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4142an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4143macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4144never both of them at once.
4145@end defmac
4146
4147@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4148Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4149it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4150@code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4151is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
41520)} is used instead.
4153@end defmac
4154
4155@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4156Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4157finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4158undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4159
4160The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4161with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4162argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4163@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4164@c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4165@c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4166@end defmac
4167
b25b9e8f
NF
4168@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE
4169This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4170advance past an argument in the argument list. The values @var{mode},
4171@var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument. Once this is done,
4172the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4173argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
38f8b050 4174
b25b9e8f 4175This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
38f8b050
JR
4176on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4177used for arguments without any special help.
b25b9e8f 4178@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
4179
4180@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4181If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4182offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4183which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4184slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4185top.
4186@end defmac
4187
4188@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4189If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4190to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4191@code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4192@code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4193
123148b5
BS
4194The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this macro, but by the
4195target hook @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}. It is
4196always just enough to reach the next multiple of that boundary.
38f8b050
JR
4197
4198This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4199For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4200big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4201constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4202@end defmac
4203
4204@defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4205If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4206implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4207next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4208controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4209arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4210@end defmac
4211
4212@defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4213Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4214memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4215macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4216machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4217@code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4218registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4219a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4220required.
4221@end defmac
4222
c2ed6cf8 4223@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY
2b0d3573 4224This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
c2ed6cf8
NF
4225with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4226@code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4227@end deftypefn
38f8b050 4228
123148b5
BS
4229@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY
4230
38f8b050
JR
4231@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4232A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4233register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4234@emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4235the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4236used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4237stack.
4238@end defmac
4239
4240@hook TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG
4241This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4242as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4243arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4244to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4245AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4246registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4247point register.
4248
4249The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4250false.
4251@end deftypefn
4252
4253@hook TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST
4254This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4255The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4256@end deftypefn
4257
07a5b2bc 4258@hook TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P
38f8b050
JR
4259This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4260to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4261variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
07a5b2bc 4262to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
38f8b050 4263variable.
07a5b2bc 4264The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
38f8b050
JR
4265this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4266internal type.
4267If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4268Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4269macro to iterate through all types.
4270@end deftypefn
4271
4272@hook TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST
4273This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4274@var{fndecl}.
4275The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4276@end deftypefn
4277
4278@hook TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE
4279This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4280type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4281@code{NULL_TREE}.
4282@end deftypefn
4283
4284@hook TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR
4285This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4286@code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4287arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4288@code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4289@end deftypefn
4290
4291@hook TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE
4292Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4293with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4294hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4295@end deftypefn
4296
7352c013
RG
4297@hook TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO
4298
38f8b050
JR
4299@hook TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4300Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4301insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4302considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4303must work.
4304
4305The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4306required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4307Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4308code in @file{optabs.c}.
4309@end deftypefn
4310
4311@hook TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4312Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4313insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4314must have move patterns for this mode.
4315@end deftypefn
4316
0f6d54f7
RS
4317@hook TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4318
38f8b050
JR
4319@hook TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P
4320Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4321small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4322@var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4323in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4324In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4325for any mode.
4326
4327On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4328insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4329to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4330if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4331insn.
4332
4333Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4334in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4335the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4336classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4337registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4338registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4339SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4340strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4341machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4342
2b0d3573 4343The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always
38f8b050
JR
4344safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4345unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4346that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4347to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4348of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4349@end deftypefn
4350
e692f276
RH
4351@hook TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
4352
38f8b050
JR
4353@node Scalar Return
4354@subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4355@cindex return values in registers
4356@cindex values, returned by functions
4357@cindex scalars, returned as values
4358
4359This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4360values---values that can fit in registers.
4361
4362@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE
4363
4364Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4365returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4366representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4367representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4368function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4369compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4370Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4371a function returns a value.
4372
4373On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4374(Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4375place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4376@code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4377The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
b25b9e8f 4378multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
38f8b050
JR
4379@code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4380location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4381the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4382that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4383port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4384@samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4385
4386If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4387the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4388@var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4389
4390If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4391node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4392pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4393convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4394known.
4395
4396Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4397which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4398the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4399different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4400
4401@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4402aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4403@code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4404@end deftypefn
4405
4406@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4407This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4408a new target instead.
4409@end defmac
4410
4411@defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4412A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4413function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4414
4415Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4416support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4417specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4418compiled.
4419@end defmac
4420
4421@hook TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE
4422Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
ff2ce160 4423function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
38f8b050
JR
4424
4425The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
ff2ce160 4426library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
38f8b050
JR
4427representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4428
4429If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4430@end deftypefn
4431
4432@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4433A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4434register in which the values of called function may come back.
4435
4436A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4437second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4438recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4439suffices:
4440
4441@smallexample
4442#define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4443@end smallexample
4444
4445If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4446function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4447should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4448
4449This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4450for a new target instead.
4451@end defmac
4452
4453@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P
4454A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4455register in which the values of called function may come back.
4456
4457A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4458second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4459recognized by this target hook.
4460
4461If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4462function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4463should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4464
4465If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4466@end deftypefn
4467
4468@defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4469Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4470need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4471saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4472@end defmac
4473
4474@hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB
4475This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4476at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4477padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4478is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4479
4480Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4481be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4482or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
44834-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4484@code{SImode} rtx.
4485@end deftypefn
4486
4487@node Aggregate Return
4488@subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4489@cindex aggregates as return values
4490@cindex large return values
4491@cindex returning aggregate values
4492@cindex structure value address
4493
4494When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4495cases), the value is not returned according to
4496@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4497caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4498should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4499address}.
4500
4501This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4502memory.
4503
4504@hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY
4505This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4506function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4507Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4508will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4509libcalls.
4510
4511Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4512by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4513takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4514possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4515definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4516values, and 0 otherwise.
4517
4518Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4519be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4520to indicate this.
4521@end deftypefn
4522
4523@defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4524Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4525in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4526only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4527If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4528and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4529target hook.
4530
4531If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4532@end defmac
4533
4534@hook TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX
4535This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4536address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4537passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4538be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4539hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4540argument.
4541
4542On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4543is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4544caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4545be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4546@var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4547the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4548the caller.
4549
4550If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4551stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4552@var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4553structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4554to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4555@end deftypefn
4556
4557@defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4558Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4559for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4560the address of a static variable containing the value.
4561
4562Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4563pass an address to the subroutine.
4564
4565This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4566nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4567@end defmac
4568
ffa88471
SE
4569@hook TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE
4570
4571@hook TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE
4572
38f8b050
JR
4573@node Caller Saves
4574@subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4575
4576If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4577makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4578must live across calls.
4579
4580@defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
4581A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
4582a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
4583restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
4584this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
4585
4586If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4587machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
4588@end defmac
4589
4590@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4591A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4592of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4593@var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4594returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4595will select the smallest suitable mode.
4596@end defmac
4597
4598@node Function Entry
4599@subsection Function Entry and Exit
4600@cindex function entry and exit
4601@cindex prologue
4602@cindex epilogue
4603
4604This section describes the macros that output function entry
4605(@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4606
4607@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE
4608If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4609function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4610initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4611saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4612local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4613stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4614
4615The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4616macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4617
4618@findex regs_ever_live
4619To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4620@code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4621@var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4622prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4623call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4624@code{regs_ever_live}.)
4625
4626On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4627not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4628they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4629appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4630registers are used in the function.
4631
4632@findex frame_pointer_needed
4633On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4634function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4635pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4636frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4637@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4638time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4639
4640The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4641required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4642listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4643order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4644stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4645the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4646for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4647compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4648or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4649need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4650@end deftypefn
4651
4652@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE
4653If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4654prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4655emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4656emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4657@end deftypefn
4658
4659@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE
4660If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4661epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4662emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4663emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4664@end deftypefn
4665
4666@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE
4667If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4668function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4669registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4670called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4671same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4672registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4673@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4674
4675On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4676of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4677instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4678@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4679
4680Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4681@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4682switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4683define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4684target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4685condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4686
4687On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4688function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4689two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4690is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4691@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4692a function that needs a frame pointer.
4693
4694Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4695@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4696The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4697function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4698
4699On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4700others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4701given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4702number of arguments.
4703
29454ff5
SL
4704@findex pops_args
4705@findex crtl->args.pops_args
38f8b050
JR
4706Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4707functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4708needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4709function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4710@code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4711@end deftypefn
4712
4713@itemize @bullet
4714@item
29454ff5
SL
4715@findex pretend_args_size
4716@findex crtl->args.pretend_args_size
4717A region of @code{crtl->args.pretend_args_size} bytes of
38f8b050
JR
4718uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4719stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4720if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4721arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4722yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4723region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4724registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4725features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4726
4727@item
4728An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4729The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4730the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4731machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4732in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4733a save area.
4734
4735@item
4736A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4737boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4738this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4739save area closer to the top of the stack.
4740
4741@item
4742@cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4743Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
29454ff5 4744@code{crtl->outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
38f8b050
JR
4745argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4746@end itemize
4747
4748@defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4749Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4750instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4751pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4752adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4753default is 0.
4754
4755Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4756frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4757stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4758compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4759@end defmac
4760
4761@defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4762Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4763used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4764pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4765@end defmac
4766
4767@defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4768Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4769used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4770on entry to an exception edge.
4771@end defmac
4772
4773@defmac DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4774Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
4775instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''. The
4776definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
4777representing the number of delay slots there.
4778@end defmac
4779
4780@defmac ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
4781A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
4782slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
4783
4784The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
4785being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
4786eligibility). It is never negative and is always less than the number
4787of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
4788If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
4789may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot. Also, other insns may
4790(at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
4791slot.
4792
29454ff5
SL
4793@findex epilogue_delay_list
4794@findex crtl->epilogue_delay_list
38f8b050
JR
4795@findex final_scan_insn
4796The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
29454ff5
SL
4797list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in
4798@code{crtl->epilogue_delay_list}. The insn for the first
38f8b050
JR
4799delay slot comes first in the list. Your definition of the macro
4800@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4801outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4802@code{final_scan_insn}.
4803
4804You need not define this macro if you did not define
4805@code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
4806@end defmac
4807
4808@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4809A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4810function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4811inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4812adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4813the real function.
4814
4815First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4816contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4817contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4818in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4819e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4820all other incoming arguments.
4821
4822Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4823made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4824adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4825
4826@smallexample
4827p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4828@end smallexample
4829
4830After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4831@code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4832not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4833return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4834
4835The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4836the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4837of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4838and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4839
4840The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4841have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4842some targets, but probably not.
4843
4844If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4845front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4846@var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4847not support varargs.
4848@end deftypefn
4849
4850@hook TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4851A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4852to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4853arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4854generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4855previously exposed.
4856@end deftypefn
4857
4858@node Profiling
4859@subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4860@cindex profiling, code generation
4861
4862These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4863
4864@defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4865A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4866assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4867
4868@findex mcount
4869The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4870your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4871compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4872compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4873
4874Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4875variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4876@samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4877the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4878@end defmac
4879
4880@defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4881A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4882code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4883not support profiling.
4884@end defmac
4885
4886@defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4887Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4888@code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4889allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4890implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4891@var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4892@end defmac
4893
4894@defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4895Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4896the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4897@end defmac
4898
4899@node Tail Calls
4900@subsection Permitting tail calls
4901@cindex tail calls
4902
4903@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
4904True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4905call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4906or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4907
4908It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4909tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4910during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4911as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4912``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4913may vary greatly between different architectures.
4914@end deftypefn
4915
4916@hook TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY
4917Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4918function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4919cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4920registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4921TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4922FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4923@end deftypefn
4924
ee3d2ecd
JJ
4925@hook TARGET_SET_UP_BY_PROLOGUE
4926
d45eae79
SL
4927@hook TARGET_WARN_FUNC_RETURN
4928
38f8b050
JR
4929@node Stack Smashing Protection
4930@subsection Stack smashing protection
4931@cindex stack smashing protection
4932
4933@hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD
4934This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4935for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
4936runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4937that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4938variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4939
4940The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4941@samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4942@end deftypefn
4943
4944@hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL
b3c144a3 4945This hook returns a @code{CALL_EXPR} that alerts the runtime that the
38f8b050
JR
4946stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4947involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4948
4949The default version of this hook invokes a function called
4950@samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
4951normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4952@end deftypefn
4953
7458026b
ILT
4954@hook TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK
4955
38f8b050
JR
4956@node Varargs
4957@section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4958@cindex varargs implementation
4959
4960GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4961@code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4962on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4963varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4964conditionals to include it.
4965
4966ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4967the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4968implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4969to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
4970@code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4971supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4972
4973However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4974the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4975below.
4976
4977@defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
4978Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4979that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
4980versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4981you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4982
4983On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
4984control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
4985other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
4986found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4987
4988Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4989beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4990@code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4991This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4992to use them for its own purposes.
4993@c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4994@c 10feb93
4995@end defmac
4996
38f8b050 4997@defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
c59a0a1d 4998This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
38f8b050
JR
4999argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
5000returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
5001argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
5002fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
5003verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
5004of the current function.
5005@end defmac
5006
5007@defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
5008Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
5009passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
5010has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
5011specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
5012with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
5013
5014@code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
5015considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
5016kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
5017
5018The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
5019interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
5020@end defmac
5021
5022These machine description macros help implement varargs:
5023
5024@hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
5025If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
5026@code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
5027beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
5028return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5029to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5030@end deftypefn
5031
5032@hook TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
5033This target hook offers an alternative to using
5034@code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5035@code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
5036register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5037have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
5038use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5039pass all their arguments on the stack.
5040
5041The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5042structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5043named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5044last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5045
5046The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5047argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5048store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5049variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5050store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5051frame.
5052
5053Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5054compile time without knowing their data types,
5055@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5056have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5057for all data types.
5058
5059If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5060arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5061happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5062end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5063not generate any instructions in this case.
5064@end deftypefn
5065
5066@hook TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
5067Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5068argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5069
b25b9e8f 5070This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
38f8b050
JR
5071is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5072@code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5073arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5074but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5075then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5076except the last are treated as named.
5077
5078You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5079@end deftypefn
5080
5081@hook TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
5082If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5083@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5084@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5085defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5086@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5087Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5088@end deftypefn
5089
5090@node Trampolines
5091@section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5092@cindex trampolines for nested functions
5093@cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5094
5095A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5096when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5097the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5098tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5099trampoline.
5100
5101The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5102address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5103the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5104two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5105exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5106machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5107two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5108operands.
5109
5110The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5111parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5112immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5113simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5114proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5115may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5116separately.
5117
5118@hook TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
5119This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5120on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5121the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5122label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5123
5124If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5125for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5126code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5127to generate it on the spot.
5128@end deftypefn
5129
5130@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5131Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5132(@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5133@end defmac
5134
5135@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5136A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5137@end defmac
5138
5139@defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5140Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5141
5142If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5143is used for aligning trampolines.
5144@end defmac
5145
5146@hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT
5147This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5148@var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5149is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5150RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5151when it is called.
5152
5153If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5154first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5155from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
ff2ce160 5156Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
38f8b050
JR
5157trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5158to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5159
5160If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
ff2ce160 5161enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
38f8b050
JR
5162initializing the trampoline proper.
5163@end deftypefn
5164
5165@hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS
5166This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5167the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5168memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5169the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5170address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5171be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5172If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5173@end deftypefn
5174
5175Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5176separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5177fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5178jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5179
5180Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5181the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5182make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5183subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5184latter makes initialization faster.
5185
5186To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5187the following macro.
5188
5189@defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5190If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5191cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5192typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5193@var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5194@end defmac
5195
38f8b050
JR
5196To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5197you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5198cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5199beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5200its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5201
5202@defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5203Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5204work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5205which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5206@code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5207
5208If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5209C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5210special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5211statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5212global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5213special assembler code.
5214@end defmac
5215
5216@node Library Calls
5217@section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5218@cindex library subroutine names
5219@cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5220
5221@c prevent bad page break with this line
5222Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5223
5224@defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5225This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5226expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5227provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5228are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5229@end defmac
5230
5231@findex set_optab_libfunc
5232@findex init_one_libfunc
5233@hook TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS
5234This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5235existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5236@code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5237@code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5238library routines.
5239
5240The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5241@end deftypefn
5242
cdbf4541
BS
5243@hook TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5244
38f8b050
JR
5245@defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5246This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5247implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5248mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5249return a tristate.
5250
5251GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5252comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5253don't need to define this macro.
5254@end defmac
5255
5256@defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5257This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5258functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5259operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5260and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5261If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5262@minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5263in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5264@end defmac
5265
38f8b050
JR
5266@cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5267@findex matherr
5268@defmac TARGET_EDOM
5269The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5270expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5271deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5272@file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5273system.
5274
5275If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5276domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5277error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5278there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5279that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5280@end defmac
5281
5282@cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5283@defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5284Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5285refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5286@code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5287macro, a reasonable default is used.
5288@end defmac
5289
5290@cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
5291@defmac TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
5292When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
5293@code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard. The
5294default is zero because a number of existing systems lack support for these
5295functions in their runtime so this macro needs to be redefined to one on
5296systems that do support the C99 runtime.
5297@end defmac
5298
5299@cindex sincos math function, implicit usage
5300@defmac TARGET_HAS_SINCOS
5301When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize calls to @code{sin}
5302and @code{cos} with the same argument to a call to @code{sincos}. The
5303default is zero. The target has to provide the following functions:
5304@smallexample
5305void sincos(double x, double *sin, double *cos);
5306void sincosf(float x, float *sin, float *cos);
5307void sincosl(long double x, long double *sin, long double *cos);
5308@end smallexample
5309@end defmac
5310
5311@defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
fea3ca91
IS
5312Set this macro to 1 to use the "NeXT" Objective-C message sending conventions
5313by default. This calling convention involves passing the object, the selector
5314and the method arguments all at once to the method-lookup library function.
5315This is the usual setting when targeting Darwin/Mac OS X systems, which have
5316the NeXT runtime installed.
5317
5318If the macro is set to 0, the "GNU" Objective-C message sending convention
5319will be used by default. This convention passes just the object and the
5320selector to the method-lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5321
5322In either case, it remains possible to select code-generation for the alternate
5323scheme, by means of compiler command line switches.
38f8b050
JR
5324@end defmac
5325
5326@node Addressing Modes
5327@section Addressing Modes
5328@cindex addressing modes
5329
5330@c prevent bad page break with this line
5331This is about addressing modes.
5332
5333@defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5334@defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5335@defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5336@defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5337A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5338pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5339@end defmac
5340
5341@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5342@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5343A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5344post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5345the size of the memory operand.
5346@end defmac
5347
5348@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5349@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5350A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5351post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5352@end defmac
5353
5354@defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5355A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5356is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5357@code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5358is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
ff2ce160 5359constant addresses are supported.
38f8b050
JR
5360@end defmac
5361
5362@defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5363@code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5364accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5365known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5366expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5367@code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5368@end defmac
5369
5370@defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5371A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5372memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5373the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5374accept.
5375@end defmac
5376
5377@hook TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
5378A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5379address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5380
5381Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5382non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5383desired by the caller.
5384
5385The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5386that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5387considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5388kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5389must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5390up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5391register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5392if the array holds @code{-1}.
5393
5394The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5395accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5396register is required.
5397
5398Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5399and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5400constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5401specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5402recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5403
5404Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5405sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5406@code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5407naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5408be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5409
5410@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5411On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5412the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5413target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5414into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5415@code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5416@code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5417Format}.
5418
5419@cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5420Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5421this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5422has this syntax:
5423
5424@example
5425#define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5426@end example
5427
5428@noindent
5429and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5430address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
6f7b223b
PK
5431
5432@findex REG_OK_STRICT
5433Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5434macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5435@code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5436that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5437
38f8b050
JR
5438Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5439files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5440@end deftypefn
5441
5442@defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5443A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5444character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5445letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5446@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5447support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5448semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5449preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5450@code{'m'} constraint.
5451@end defmac
5452
5453@defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5454A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5455or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5456can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5457@code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5458
5459It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5460that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5461
5462The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5463a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5464@end defmac
5465
5466@hook TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5467This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5468operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5469address.
5470
5471@findex break_out_memory_refs
5472@var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5473and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5474@var{x}.
5475
5476The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5477@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5478should return the new @var{x}.
5479
f938987f
HPN
5480It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address,
5481with the exception of native TLS addresses (@pxref{Emulated TLS}).
5482The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, if
5483the target supports only emulated TLS, it
38f8b050
JR
5484is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5485a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5486strategy can generate better code.
5487@end deftypefn
5488
5489@defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5490A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5491that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5492@var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5493It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5494performance reasons.
5495
5496For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5497reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5498registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5499processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5500needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5501@code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5502generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5503be shared.
5504
5505@emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5506to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5507and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5508of reload internals.
5509
5510@emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5511previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5512then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5513
5514@findex push_reload
5515The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5516need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5517suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5518
5519The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5520@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5521should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5522This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5523@code{push_reload}.
5524
5525@findex strict_memory_address_p
5526The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5527the address has become legitimate.
5528
5529@findex copy_rtx
5530If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5531this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5532single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5533top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5534It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5535address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5536@end defmac
5537
5538@hook TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P
5bfed9a9
GJL
5539This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} in address
5540space @var{addrspace} can have
38f8b050
JR
5541different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5542reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5543but not others.
5544
5545Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5546effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5547of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5548addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5549
5550You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5551
5552The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5553@end deftypefn
5554
1a627b35
RS
5555@hook TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P
5556This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5557@var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5558@var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5559
5560The default definition returns true.
5561@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
5562
5563@hook TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5564This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5565@code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5566macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5567references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5568addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5569the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5570into their original form.
5571@end deftypefn
5572
93bcc8c9
JJ
5573@hook TARGET_CONST_NOT_OK_FOR_DEBUG_P
5574This hook should return true if @var{x} should not be emitted into
5575debug sections.
5576@end deftypefn
5577
38f8b050
JR
5578@hook TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM
5579This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
fbbf66e7
RS
5580should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode
5581of @var{x}.
5582
5583The default version of this hook returns false.
38f8b050
JR
5584
5585The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5586deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5587from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5588holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5589of TLS symbols for various targets.
5590@end deftypefn
5591
5592@hook TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P
5593This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5594be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5595of @var{x}.
5596
5597The default version returns false for all constants.
5598@end deftypefn
5599
89356d17 5600@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL
38f8b050
JR
5601This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
5602the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5603@code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
5604when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5605@var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5606of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5607function are valid.
5608@end deftypefn
5609
5610@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD
5611This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5612address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5613used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5614@var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5615
5616The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5617@var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5618the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5619@code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5620two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5621@var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5622the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5623from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5624@var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5625@var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5626@var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5627
5628If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5629to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5630use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5631@code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5632should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5633described above.
5634If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5635the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5636log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5637@end deftypefn
5638
38f8b050
JR
5639@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST
5640Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
ff2ce160 5641For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
720f5239 5642misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
38f8b050
JR
5643@end deftypefn
5644
5645@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE
5646Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5647@end deftypefn
5648
5a3c0068 5649@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_VEC_PERM_CONST_OK
5dea5b2a 5650Return true if a vector created for @code{vec_perm_const} is valid.
38f8b050
JR
5651@end deftypefn
5652
5653@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION
5654This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5655input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5656The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5657specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5658(truncation, rounding, etc.).
5659
5660If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5661@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5662conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5663@end deftypefn
5664
5665@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION
5666This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5667vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5668@var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5669The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5670return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5671@var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5672@end deftypefn
5673
5674@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT
5675This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5676store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5677parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5678the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5679parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5680@end deftypefn
5681
cc4b5170
RG
5682@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE
5683This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5684mode @var{mode}. The default is
5685equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
26983c22
L
5686transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5687@end deftypefn
5688
767f865f
RG
5689@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES
5690This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5691after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5692mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5693The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5694@end deftypefn
5695
c3e7ee41
BS
5696@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST
5697
5698@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_ADD_STMT_COST
5699
5700@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_FINISH_COST
5701
5702@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_DESTROY_COST_DATA
5703
0a35513e
AH
5704@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_LOAD
5705
5706@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_STORE
5707
aec7ae7d
JJ
5708@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_GATHER
5709Target builtin that implements vector gather operation. @var{mem_vectype}
5710is the vector type of the load and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5711the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5712The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize gather
5713loads.
5714@end deftypefn
5715
38f8b050
JR
5716@node Anchored Addresses
5717@section Anchored Addresses
5718@cindex anchored addresses
5719@cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5720
5721GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5722For example, if we have:
5723
5724@smallexample
5725static int a, b, c;
5726int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5727@end smallexample
5728
5729the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5730addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5731it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5732the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5733be something like:
5734
5735@smallexample
5736int foo (void)
5737@{
5738 register int *xr = &x;
5739 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5740@}
5741@end smallexample
5742
5743(which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5744``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5745
5746The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5747in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5748section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5749or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5750
5751@hook TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5752The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5753On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5754applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5755for every mode. The default value is 0.
5756@end deftypevr
5757
5758@hook TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5759Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5760offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5761value is 0.
5762@end deftypevr
5763
5764@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR
5765Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5766@code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5767The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5768of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5769
5770If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5771it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5772If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5773is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5774@end deftypefn
5775
5776@hook TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P
5777Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5778@var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5779@samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5780
5781The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5782intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5783or target-specific sections.
5784@end deftypefn
5785
5786@node Condition Code
5787@section Condition Code Status
5788@cindex condition code status
5789
5790The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5791two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5792
5793The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5794(@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5795clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5796register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5797architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5798most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5799most RISC machines.
5800
5801The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5802the definition and use of the condition code, which need to be in adjacent
5803insns for machines using @code{(cc0)}. This can prevent important
5804optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5805is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5806three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5807scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5808separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5809
5810For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5811represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5812condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5813condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5814or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5815Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5816that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5817
5818Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5819specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5820interested in most macros in this section.
5821
5822@menu
5823* CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5824* MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
ac7eb5c6 5825* Cond Exec Macros:: Macros to control conditional execution.
38f8b050
JR
5826@end menu
5827
5828@node CC0 Condition Codes
5829@subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5830@findex cc0
5831
5832@findex cc_status
5833The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5834describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5835the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5836variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5837currently based, and several standard flags.
5838
5839Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5840description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5841information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5842
5843@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5844C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5845component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5846
5847This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5848@end defmac
5849
5850@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5851A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5852The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5853the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5854define this macro to initialize it.
5855
5856This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5857@end defmac
5858
5859@defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5860A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5861appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5862this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5863code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5864set @code{(cc0)}.
5865
5866This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5867
5868If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5869other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5870invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5871reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5872registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5873@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5874insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5875based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5876value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5877this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5878@samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5879@code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5880condition code value.
5881
5882The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5883with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5884@code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5885constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5886insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5887@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5888@code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5889
5890A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5891that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5892@samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5893two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5894@end defmac
5895
5896@node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5897@subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5898@findex CCmode
5899@findex MODE_CC
5900
5901@defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5902On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5903than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5904code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
5905when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
5906bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
5907branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
5908this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
5909record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
5910also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
5911unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
5912
5913If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
5914@file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
5915a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
5916have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
5917by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
5918be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
5919the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
5920
5921@smallexample
5922(define_insn ""
5923 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
5924 (compare:CC_NOOV
5925 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
5926 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
5927 (const_int 0)))]
5928 ""
5929 "@dots{}")
5930@end smallexample
5931
5932@noindent
5933together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
5934for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
5935
5936@smallexample
5937#define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
5938 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
5939 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
5940 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
5941 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
5942 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
5943@end smallexample
5944
5945Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
5946were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
5947this section.
5948
5949You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
5950in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
5951@end defmac
5952
5953@defmac CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
5954On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
5955convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
5956does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
5957comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
5958
5959On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
5960required conversions. @var{code} is the initial comparison code
5961and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
5962comparison, respectively. You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
5963@var{op1} as required.
5964
5965GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
5966valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
5967@file{md} file.
5968
5969You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
5970code or operands.
5971@end defmac
5972
5973@defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
5974A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
5975comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
5976can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
5977then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
5978
5979You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
5980floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
5981For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
5982inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
5983
5984@smallexample
5985#define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
5986@end smallexample
5987@end defmac
5988
5989@defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
5990A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
5991comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
5992@code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
5993machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
5994instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
5995freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
5996like:
5997
5998@smallexample
5999#define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6000 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6001 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6002@end smallexample
6003@end defmac
6004
6005@hook TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS
6006On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6007register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6008regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6009hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6010small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6011to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6012arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6013When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6014integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6015@code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6016
6017The default version of this hook returns false.
6018@end deftypefn
6019
6020@hook TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE
6021On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6022@code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6023validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6024target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6025both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6026return @code{VOIDmode}.
6027
6028The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6029same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6030returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6031@end deftypefn
6032
ac7eb5c6 6033@node Cond Exec Macros
38f8b050
JR
6034@subsection Macros to control conditional execution
6035@findex conditional execution
6036@findex predication
6037
6038There is one macro that may need to be defined for targets
6039supporting conditional execution, independent of how they
6040represent conditional branches.
6041
38f8b050
JR
6042@node Costs
6043@section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6044@cindex costs of instructions
6045@cindex relative costs
6046@cindex speed of instructions
6047
6048These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6049on the target machine.
6050
6051@defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6052A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6053register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6054expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6055value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6056that.
6057
6058It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6059same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6060registers if they are not general registers.
6061
6062If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6063hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6064classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6065constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6066allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6067if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6068
6069These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6070@code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6071@end defmac
6072
6073@hook TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST
6074This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6075from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6076are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6077A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6078that.
6079
6080It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6081same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6082registers if they are not general registers.
6083
6084If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6085hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6086classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6087constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6088allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6089if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6090
6091The default version of this function returns 2.
6092@end deftypefn
6093
6094@defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6095A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6096register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6097is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6098is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6099registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6100should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6101
6102If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6103the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6104needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6105between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6106more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6107reflect the actual cost of the move.
6108
6109GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6110secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6111a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6112secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
61134 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6114value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6115are the same as to this macro.
6116
6117These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6118@code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6119@end defmac
6120
911852ff 6121@hook TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST
38f8b050 6122This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
911852ff 6123between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
38f8b050
JR
6124if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6125This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6126If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6127registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6128
6129If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6130the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6131needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
911852ff 6132between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
38f8b050
JR
6133more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6134reflect the actual cost of the move.
6135
6136GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6137secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6138a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6139secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
61404 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6141value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6142are the same as to this target hook.
6143@end deftypefn
6144
6145@defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
525d13b0
MS
6146A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
6147the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6148@var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6149for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6150optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
6151true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6152@code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
38f8b050
JR
6153@end defmac
6154
6155Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6156but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6157ordinarily expect.
6158
6159@defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6160Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6161than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6162faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6163require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6164between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6165
6166When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6167finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6168load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6169faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6170may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6171other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6172@end defmac
6173
6174@defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6175Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6176@var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6177than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6178handler.
6179
6180When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6181@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6182moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6183Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6184cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6185
6186If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6187this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6188@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6189@end defmac
6190
6191@defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6192The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6193which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6194string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6195make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6196
6197Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6198@code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6199the number of such sequences.
6200
6201The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6202optimized for speed rather than size.
6203
6204If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6205@end defmac
6206
6207@defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6208A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
6209copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
6210will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6211than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6212@end defmac
6213
6214@defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6215A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6216a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6217@end defmac
6218
6219@defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6220The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6221of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6222or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6223eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6224
6225The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6226optimized for speed rather than size.
6227
6228If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6229@end defmac
6230
6231@defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6232A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
6233to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
6234will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6235than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
6236@end defmac
6237
6238@defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6239The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6240of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
ff2ce160 6241a block set insn or a library call.
38f8b050
JR
6242Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6243eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6244
6245The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6246optimized for speed rather than size.
6247
6248If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6249@end defmac
6250
6251@defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6252A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
ff2ce160
MS
6253used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
6254other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
38f8b050
JR
6255storing values other than constant zero.
6256Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6257than @code{SET_RATIO}.
6258@end defmac
6259
6260@defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6261A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6262used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
6263other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
6264called with a constant source string.
6265Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6266than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6267@end defmac
6268
6269@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6270A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6271thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6272@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6273@end defmac
6274
6275@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6276A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6277thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6278@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6279@end defmac
6280
6281@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6282A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6283thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6284@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6285@end defmac
6286
6287@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6288A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6289thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6290@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6291@end defmac
6292
6293@defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6294A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6295thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6296@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6297@end defmac
6298
6299@defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6300A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6301thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6302@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6303@end defmac
6304
6305@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6306This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6307thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6308@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6309@end defmac
6310
6311@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6312This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6313thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6314@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6315@end defmac
6316
6317@defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6318Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
6319function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6320@end defmac
6321
a8d56c30
SB
6322@defmac LOGICAL_OP_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6323Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6324@samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6325@code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6326@end defmac
6327
38f8b050
JR
6328@hook TARGET_RTX_COSTS
6329This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6330
6331The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
68f932c4
RS
6332available for examination in @var{x}, and the fact that @var{x} appears
6333as operand @var{opno} of an expression with rtx code @var{outer_code}.
6334That is, the hook can assume that there is some rtx @var{y} such
6335that @samp{GET_CODE (@var{y}) == @var{outer_code}} and such that
6336either (a) @samp{XEXP (@var{y}, @var{opno}) == @var{x}} or
6337(b) @samp{XVEC (@var{y}, @var{opno})} contains @var{x}.
6338
6339@var{code} is @var{x}'s expression code---redundant, since it can be
6340obtained with @code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
38f8b050
JR
6341
6342In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6343@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6344instructions.
6345
6346On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6347for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6348necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6349for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6350operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6351
6352When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6353false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6354size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6355
6356The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6357processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6358@end deftypefn
6359
6360@hook TARGET_ADDRESS_COST
6361This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6362@var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6363the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6364
6365For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6366true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6367instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6368all addresses will have equal costs.
6369
6370In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6371the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6372cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6373
6374For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6375and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6376is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6377references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6378the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6379that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6380instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6381specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6382
6383This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6384
6385On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6386cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6387@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6388be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6389@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6390should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6391should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6392registers on machines with lots of registers.
6393@end deftypefn
6394
6395@node Scheduling
6396@section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6397
6398The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6399adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6400hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6401them: try the first ones in this list first.
6402
6403@hook TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE
6404This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6405issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6406Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6407an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6408constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6409hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6410This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6411it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6412@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6413@end deftypefn
6414
6415@hook TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE
6416This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6417from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6418still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6419@samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6420@code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6421You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6422than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6423@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6424debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6425@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6426was scheduled.
6427@end deftypefn
6428
6429@hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST
6430This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6431relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6432dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6433is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6434to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
6435that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
6436data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6437description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6438output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6439times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6440acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6441@pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6442@end deftypefn
6443
6444@hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY
6445This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6446@var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6447execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6448later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6449scheduling priorities of insns.
6450@end deftypefn
6451
6452@hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER
6453This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6454list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6455combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6456@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6457debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6458@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6459list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6460a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6461reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6462@var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6463is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6464the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6465can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6466@samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6467@end deftypefn
6468
6469@hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2
6470Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6471function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6472is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6473@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6474return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6475this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6476scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6477cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6478@end deftypefn
6479
6480@hook TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK
6481This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6482chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6483correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6484example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6485analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6486dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6487calculated.
6488@end deftypefn
6489
6490@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT
6491This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6492instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6493pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6494is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6495@var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6496region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6497scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6498@end deftypefn
6499
6500@hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH
6501This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6502instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6503cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6504is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6505to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6506@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6507@end deftypefn
6508
6509@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL
6510This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6511@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6512@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6513@var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6514@end deftypefn
6515
6516@hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL
6517This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6518@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6519@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6520@end deftypefn
6521
6522@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6523The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6524pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6525when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6526simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6527processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6528based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6529when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6530@end deftypefn
6531
6532@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6533The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6534@end deftypefn
6535
6536@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6537The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6538to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6539simulated processor cycle finishes.
6540@end deftypefn
6541
6542@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6543The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6544used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6545@end deftypefn
6546
6547@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6548The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6549The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6550to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6551state on a single insn is not enough.
6552@end deftypefn
6553
6554@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6555The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6556The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6557to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6558state on a single insn is not enough.
6559@end deftypefn
6560
6561@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD
6562This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6563for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6564chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6565value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6566@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6567subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6568maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6569@acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6570packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6571rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6572
6573This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6574processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6575with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6576@var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6577@var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6578processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6579@var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6580until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6581the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6582
6583Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6584pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6585schedules to choose the best one.
6586
6587The default is no multipass scheduling.
6588@end deftypefn
6589
6590@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD
6591
6592This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6593considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6594zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be not chosen to
6595be issued.
6596
6597The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6598@end deftypefn
6599
894fd6f2
MK
6600@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN
6601This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6602scheduling.
6603@end deftypefn
6604
6605@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE
6606This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6607@end deftypefn
6608
6609@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK
6610This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6611an instruction.
6612@end deftypefn
6613
6614@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END
6615This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6616round of multipass scheduling.
6617@end deftypefn
6618
6619@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT
2b0d3573 6620This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
894fd6f2
MK
6621@end deftypefn
6622
6623@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI
2b0d3573 6624This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
894fd6f2
MK
6625@end deftypefn
6626
c06bbdf7 6627@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE
38f8b050
JR
6628This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6629on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6630@var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6631the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6632is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6633start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6634verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6635@var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6636processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6637and the current processor cycle.
6638@end deftypefn
6639
6640@hook TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE
6641This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6642the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6643are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6644to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6645being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6646dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6647parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6648The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6649insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6650and @code{false} otherwise.
6651
6652Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6653where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6654delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6655that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6656important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6657closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6658not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6659@end deftypefn
6660
6661@hook TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED
6662This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6663the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6664per instruction data structures.
6665@end deftypefn
6666
6667@hook TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT
6668Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6669@end deftypefn
6670
6671@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT
6672Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6673It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6674beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6675@end deftypefn
6676
6677@hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT
6678Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6679@end deftypefn
6680
6681@hook TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT
6682Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6683@end deftypefn
6684
6685@hook TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT
6686Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6687@end deftypefn
6688
6689@hook TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN
6690This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6691speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6692The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6693version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6694pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6695or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6696speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6697the generated speculative pattern.
6698@end deftypefn
6699
6700@hook TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P
6701This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6702for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6703instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6704@end deftypefn
6705
6706@hook TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK
6707This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6708check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6709speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6710@var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6711be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6712recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6713a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6714@var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6715@end deftypefn
6716
6717@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC
6718This hook is used as a workaround for
6719@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
6720called on the first instruction of the ready list. The hook is used to
6721discard speculative instructions that stand first in the ready list from
6722being scheduled on the current cycle. If the hook returns @code{false},
6723@var{insn} will not be chosen to be issued.
6724For non-speculative instructions,
6725the hook should always return @code{true}. For example, in the ia64 backend
6726the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
6727is nearly full.
6728@end deftypefn
6729
6730@hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS
6731This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6732enabled/used.
6733The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6734The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6735@end deftypefn
6736
6737@hook TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII
6738This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6739resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6740the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6741backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6742bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6743of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6744@end deftypefn
6745
7942e47e
RY
6746@hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH
6747This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6748is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6749@end deftypefn
6750
6751@hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO
6752This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6753in its second parameter.
6754@end deftypefn
6755
b0bd15f7
BS
6756@hook TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
6757
df7b0cc4
EI
6758@hook TARGET_SCHED_REASSOCIATION_WIDTH
6759
38f8b050
JR
6760@node Sections
6761@section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6762@c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6763@c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6764
6765An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6766data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6767section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6768section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6769section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6770of sections.
6771
6772@file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6773@code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6774The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6775is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6776as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6777initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6778They may however depend on command-line flags.
6779
6780@emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6781use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6782to be string literals.
6783
6784Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6785section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6786should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6787@code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6788
6789You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6790@code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6791in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6792@code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6793create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6794reuse @code{text_section}.
6795
6796All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6797if the target does not provide them.
6798
6799@defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6800A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6801assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6802Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
6803@end defmac
6804
6805@defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6806If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6807frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
6808a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6809@end defmac
6810
6811@defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6812If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6813executed functions in the program.
6814@end defmac
6815
6816@defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6817A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6818assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6819data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
6820@end defmac
6821
6822@defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6823If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6824containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6825initialized, writable small data.
6826@end defmac
6827
6828@defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6829A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6830assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6831data.
6832@end defmac
6833
6834@defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6835If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6836containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
07c5f94e
AS
6837uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
6838@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
38f8b050
JR
6839uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
6840@option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
6841used.
6842@end defmac
6843
6844@defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6845If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6846containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6847uninitialized, writable small data.
6848@end defmac
6849
6850@defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6851If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6852assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6853common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6854@end defmac
6855
6856@defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6857If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6858containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
6859default is @code{'T'}.
6860@end defmac
6861
6862@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6863If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6864containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6865initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6866not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6867variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6868@end defmac
6869
6870@defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
6871If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6872containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6873finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6874not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6875variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6876@end defmac
6877
6878@defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6879If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6880containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6881part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6882defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6883both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6884@end defmac
6885
6886@defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6887If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6888containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6889part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6890defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6891both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6892@end defmac
6893
6894@defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
6895If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
6896via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
6897the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
6898@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
6899to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
6900sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
6901ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
6902registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
6903constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
6904@end defmac
6905
6906@defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
6907If defined, a string which names the section into which small
6908variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
6909when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
6910you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
6911they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
6912expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
6913MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
6914require small data support from your application, but use this macro
6915to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
6916access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
6917@end defmac
6918
6919@defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
6920If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
6921arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
6922@code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
6923and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
6924@end defmac
6925
6926@defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
6927Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
6928tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
6929section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
6930readonly data section is used.
6931
6932This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
6933@end defmac
6934
6935@hook TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS
6936Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
6937@file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
6938of its own that you need to create.
6939
6940GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
6941any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
6942described below.
6943@end deftypefn
6944
6945@hook TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK
6946Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
6947selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
6948should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
6949local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
6950
6951The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
6952is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
6953when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
6954in read-only sections even in executables.
6955@end deftypefn
6956
6957@hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION
6958Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
6959assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
6960some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
6961requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
6962local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
6963@var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
6964
6965The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
6966variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
6967
6968See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
6969@end deftypefn
6970
6971@defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
6972Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
6973for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
6974
6975In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
6976function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
6977it is unlikely to be called.
6978@end defmac
6979
6980@hook TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION
6981Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
6982and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
6983As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
6984the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
6985
6986The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
6987ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
6988example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
6989Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
6990@end deftypefn
6991
6992@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION
6993Return the readonly data section associated with
6994@samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
6995The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
6996the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
6997if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
6998otherwise.
6999@end deftypefn
7000
727a65e6
BS
7001@hook TARGET_ASM_MERGEABLE_RODATA_PREFIX
7002
50b0b78a
IS
7003@hook TARGET_ASM_TM_CLONE_TABLE_SECTION
7004
38f8b050
JR
7005@hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION
7006Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7007should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7008constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7009case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7010in bits.
7011
7012The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7013constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7014else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7015@end deftypefn
7016
7017@hook TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME
7018Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7019by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7020the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7021or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7022hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7023your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7024returns the @var{id} provided.
7025@end deftypefn
7026
7027@hook TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO
7028Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7029treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7030function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7031
7032The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7033@var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7034an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7035rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7036in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7037
7038In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7039a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7040will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7041register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7042rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7043leave it alone.)
7044
7045The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7046that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7047be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7048declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7049declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7050@var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7051
7052@cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7053The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7054@code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7055Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7056encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7057discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7058
7059The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7060in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7061@code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7062before overriding it.
7063@end deftypefn
7064
7065@hook TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING
7066Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7067the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7068may have added.
7069@end deftypefn
7070
7071@hook TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P
7072Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7073The default version of this hook always returns false.
7074@end deftypefn
7075
7076@hook TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7077Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7078``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7079@end deftypevr
7080
3c5273a9
KT
7081@hook TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
7082
38f8b050
JR
7083@hook TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P
7084Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7085rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7086or executable image).
7087
7088The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7089for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7090currently supported object file formats.
7091@end deftypefn
7092
7093@hook TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7094Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7095The default value is false.
7096@end deftypevr
7097
7098
7099@node PIC
7100@section Position Independent Code
7101@cindex position independent code
7102@cindex PIC
7103
7104This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7105independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7106generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7107@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7108@code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7109must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7110when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7111need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7112relative addresses.
ff2ce160 7113@c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
38f8b050
JR
7114@c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7115
7116@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7117The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7118data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7119processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7120is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7121pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7122is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7123necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7124when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7125@end defmac
7126
7127@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
f8fe0a4a
JM
7128A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7129@code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7130the default is zero. Do not define
38f8b050
JR
7131this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7132@end defmac
7133
7134@defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7135A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7136operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7137You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7138check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7139check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7140(including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7141position independent code.
7142@end defmac
7143
7144@node Assembler Format
7145@section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7146
7147This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7148to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7149instructions do.
7150
7151@menu
7152* File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7153* Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7154* Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7155* Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7156* Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7157 and termination routines.
7158* Macros for Initialization::
7159 Specific macros that control the handling of
7160 initialization and termination routines.
7161* Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7162* Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7163* Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7164* Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7165@end menu
7166
7167@node File Framework
7168@subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7169@cindex assembler format
7170@cindex output of assembler code
7171
7172@c prevent bad page break with this line
7173This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7174
7175@findex default_file_start
7176@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START
7177Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7178find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7179by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7180quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7181@code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7182lets other target files rely on these variables.
7183@end deftypefn
7184
7185@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7186If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7187printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7188@option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7189to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7190definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7191assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7192whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7193
7194The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7195verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7196comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7197@end deftypevr
7198
7199@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7200If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7201for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7202@code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7203this to be done. The default is false.
7204@end deftypevr
7205
7206@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_END
7207Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7208to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7209@end deftypefn
7210
7211@deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7212Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7213special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7214the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7215should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7216need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7217this function.
7218@end deftypefun
7219
7220@hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_START
7221Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7222to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7223nothing.
7224@end deftypefn
7225
7226@hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_END
7227Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7228to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7229nothing.
7230@end deftypefn
7231
7232@hook TARGET_ASM_CODE_END
7233Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7234unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7235here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7236because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7237nothing.
7238@end deftypefn
7239
7240@defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7241A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7242assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7243the end of the line.
7244@end defmac
7245
7246@defmac ASM_APP_ON
7247A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7248statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7249@code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7250assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7251that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7252@end defmac
7253
7254@defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7255A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7256statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7257@code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7258time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7259@end defmac
7260
7261@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7262A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7263which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7264the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7265
7266This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7267for the file format in use is appropriate.
7268@end defmac
7269
b5f5d41d
AS
7270@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
7271
a8781821
SB
7272@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT
7273
38f8b050
JR
7274@defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7275A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7276@var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7277in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7278the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7279of the filename using this macro.
7280@end defmac
7281
38f8b050
JR
7282@hook TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION
7283Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7284should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7285of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7286is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7287this section is associated.
7288@end deftypefn
7289
f16d3f39
JH
7290@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION
7291Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7292Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
ff2ce160 7293functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
f16d3f39
JH
7294at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7295@var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7296(from static destructors).
7297Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7298@end deftypefn
7299
14d11d40
IS
7300@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS
7301
38f8b050
JR
7302@hook TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7303This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
d5fabb58 7304It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
38f8b050
JR
7305@end deftypevr
7306
7307@anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7308@hook TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7309This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7310section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7311This is true on most ELF targets.
7312@end deftypevr
7313
7314@hook TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS
7315Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7316based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7317declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7318null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7319
7320The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7321read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7322need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7323set via @code{__attribute__}.
7324@end deftypefn
7325
7326@hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES
7327Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7328switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7329enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7330It can take the following values:
7331
7332@table @gcctabopt
7333@item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7334@var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7335
7336@item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7337@var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7338direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7339default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7340command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7341various different individual optimization passes.
7342
7343@item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7344@var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7345ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7346target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7347time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7348warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7349wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7350necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7351perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7352switches.
7353
7354@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7355This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7356
7357@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7358This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7359@end table
7360
7361The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7362supported in the future.
7363
7364By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7365provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7366it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7367section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7368provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7369hook.
7370@end deftypefn
7371
7372@hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7373This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7374ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7375hook.
7376@end deftypevr
7377
7378@need 2000
7379@node Data Output
7380@subsection Output of Data
7381
7382
7383@hook TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7384@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7385@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7386@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7387@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7388@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7389@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7390@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7391@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7392These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7393of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7394byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7395aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7396@code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7397
7398The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7399followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7400the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7401@end deftypevr
7402
7403@hook TARGET_ASM_INTEGER
7404The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7405integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7406in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7407function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7408object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7409split the object into smaller parts.
7410
7411The default implementation of this hook will use the
7412@code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7413when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7414@end deftypefn
7415
6cbd8875
AS
7416@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA
7417A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7418can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7419the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7420@code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7421
7422If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7423so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7424itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7425return @code{true}.
7426@end deftypefn
7427
38f8b050
JR
7428@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7429A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7430instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7431bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7432@code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7433
7434If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7435Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7436@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7437@end defmac
7438
7439@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7440A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7441@var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7442is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7443@end defmac
7444
7445@defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7446You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7447expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7448pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7449GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7450not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7451pool before the function.
7452@end defmac
7453
7454@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7455A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7456constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7457the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7458be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7459is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7460immediately after this call.
7461
7462If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7463not be defined.
7464@end defmac
7465
7466@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7467A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7468constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7469anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7470
7471The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7472assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7473output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7474@samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7475@var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7476alignment.
7477
7478The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7479the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7480responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7481Here is how to do this:
7482
7483@smallexample
7484@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7485@end smallexample
7486
7487When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7488@code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7489entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7490
7491You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7492@end defmac
7493
7494@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7495A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7496pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7497function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7498obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7499constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7500
7501If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7502define this macro.
7503@end defmac
7504
7505@defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7506Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7507used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7508to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7509a line separator uses multiple characters.
7510
7511If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7512the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7513@end defmac
7514
7515@hook TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7516These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7517assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7518default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7519@end deftypevr
7520
7521These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7522of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7523
7524@defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7525@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7526@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7527@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7528@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7529@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7530These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7531target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7532the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7533@code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7534simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7535@code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7536by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7537it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
753832 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7539on the host machine.
7540
7541The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7542using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7543machine's memory.
7544@end defmac
7545
7546@node Uninitialized Data
7547@subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7548
7549Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7550outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7551
7552@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7553A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7554@var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7555@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7556is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7557possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7558other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7559backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7560byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7561equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7562the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7563an ordinary undefined external.
7564
7565Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7566output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7567assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7568
7569This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7570common global variables are output.
7571@end defmac
7572
7573@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7574Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7575separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7576place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7577handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7578as the number of bits.
7579@end defmac
7580
7581@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7582Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7583variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7584is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7585in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7586@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7587the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7588@end defmac
7589
07c5f94e 7590@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
38f8b050
JR
7591A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7592@var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
07c5f94e
AS
7593@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
7594is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
38f8b050 7595
07c5f94e
AS
7596Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7597@file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
38f8b050
JR
7598@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7599before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7600the name, and a newline.
7601
07c5f94e 7602There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
38f8b050
JR
7603The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7604switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7605You do not need to do both.
7606
7607Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7608non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7609efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7610not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7611common in order to save space in the object file.
7612@end defmac
7613
38f8b050
JR
7614@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7615A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7616@var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7617@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7618is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7619
7620Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7621output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7622assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7623
7624This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7625static variables are output.
7626@end defmac
7627
7628@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7629Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7630separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7631place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7632handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7633as the number of bits.
7634@end defmac
7635
7636@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7637Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7638variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7639is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7640in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7641@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7642the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7643@end defmac
7644
7645@node Label Output
7646@subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7647
7648@c prevent bad page break with this line
7649This is about outputting labels.
7650
7651@findex assemble_name
7652@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7653A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7654@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7655Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7656output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7657assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7658definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7659@end defmac
7660
135a687e
KT
7661@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7662A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7663@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7664a function.
7665Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7666output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7667assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7668definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7669
7670If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7671usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7672@end defmac
7673
38f8b050
JR
7674@findex assemble_name_raw
7675@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7676Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
7677to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7678@code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7679that it is more efficient.
7680@end defmac
7681
7682@defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
7683A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7684size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7685default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7686systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7687
7688Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7689of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7690for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7691macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7692define this macro.
7693@end defmac
7694
7695@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
7696A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7697@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7698symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7699If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7700provided.
7701@end defmac
7702
7703@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7704A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7705@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
7706the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
7707address.
7708
7709If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7710provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7711@samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7712the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7713not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7714to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
7715@end defmac
7716
e537ef59
GP
7717@defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
7718Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
7719@samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
7720G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
7721@samp{.} is used instead.
7722@end defmac
7723
7724@defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
7725Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
7726@samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
7727have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
7728are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
7729@end defmac
7730
38f8b050
JR
7731@defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
7732A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7733type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7734default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7735systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7736
7737Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7738@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7739custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7740types at all, do not define this macro.
7741@end defmac
7742
7743@defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
7744A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7745the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7746default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7747the default is not to define this macro.
7748
7749Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7750@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7751custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7752types at all, do not define this macro.
7753@end defmac
7754
7755@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7756A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7757@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7758symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7759that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7760you should not count on this.
7761
7762If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7763definition of this macro is provided.
7764@end defmac
7765
7766@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7767A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7768@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7769function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7770outputting the label definition (perhaps using
135a687e 7771@code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
38f8b050
JR
7772@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7773
7774If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
135a687e 7775usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
38f8b050
JR
7776
7777You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7778of this macro.
7779@end defmac
7780
7781@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7782A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7783@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7784which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7785function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7786representing the function.
7787
7788If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7789
7790You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7791of this macro.
7792@end defmac
7793
7794@defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7795A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7796@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7797initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
7798label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
7799@var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7800
7801If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7802usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7803
7804You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7805@code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
7806@end defmac
7807
ad78130c 7808@hook TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME
38f8b050
JR
7809A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7810for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
7811target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7812@code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7813and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
7814will be an internal label.
7815
7816The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7817usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
7818
7819You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7820@end deftypefn
7821
7822@defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
7823A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7824@var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7825for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7826
7827If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7828nothing.
7829@end defmac
7830
7831@defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
7832A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7833once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7834chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7835initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7836something about the size of the object.
7837
7838If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7839nothing.
7840
7841You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7842@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
7843@end defmac
7844
7845@hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL
7846This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7847@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
7848that is, available for reference from other files.
7849
7850The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7851@code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
7852@end deftypefn
7853
7854@hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME
7855This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7856@var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
7857global; that is, available for reference from other files.
7858
7859The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
7860@end deftypefn
7861
7862@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7863A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7864@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7865that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7866no other definition is available. Use the expression
7867@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7868itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
7869for making that name weak, and a newline.
7870
7871If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
7872support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
7873macro.
7874@end defmac
7875
7876@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7877Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
7878@code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
7879or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
7880should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
7881defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
7882@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
7883to make @var{name} weak.
7884@end defmac
7885
7886@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7887Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
7888symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
7889declaration of @code{name}.
7890@end defmac
7891
7892@defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
74b90fe2
JDA
7893A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
7894supports weak symbols.
38f8b050
JR
7895
7896If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7897definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
74b90fe2
JDA
7898is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
7899@end defmac
7900
7901@defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
7902A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
7903
7904If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7905definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
7906this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
7907flag such as @option{-melf}.
38f8b050
JR
7908@end defmac
7909
7910@defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
7911A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
7912public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
7913be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
7914format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
7915section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
7916requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
7917@end defmac
7918
7919@defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
7920A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
7921semantics.
7922
7923If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
7924definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
7925definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
7926you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
7927setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
7928be emitted as one-only.
7929@end defmac
7930
7931@hook TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY
7932This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
7933commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
7934hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
7935@end deftypefn
7936
7937@defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
7938A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
7939that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
7940The default is @code{0}.
7941
7942Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
7943if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
7944will have undefined references from other translation units, that
7945symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
7946thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
7947(explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
7948with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
7949
7950The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
7951targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
7952restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
7953table of contents.
7954@end defmac
7955
7956@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
7957A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7958@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
7959symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
7960not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
7961declaration.
7962
7963This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
7964The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
7965@end defmac
7966
7967@hook TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL
7968This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7969pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
7970library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
7971@end deftypefn
7972
7973@hook TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED
7974This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7975directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
7976.no_dead_code_strip directive.
7977@end deftypefn
7978
7979@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7980A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7981@var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
7982@var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
7983is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
7984systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
7985@end defmac
7986
77754180
DK
7987@hook TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME
7988
38f8b050
JR
7989@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
7990A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
7991@code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
7992will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
7993to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
7994encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
7995@end defmac
7996
7997@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
7998A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
7999result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
8000@code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8001This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8002specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
8003when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8004being taken.
8005@end defmac
8006
8007@hook TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL
8008A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8009name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8010
8011It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8012used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8013will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8014
8015It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8016object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8017should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8018beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8019convention your system uses, and follow it.
8020
8021The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8022@end deftypefn
8023
8024@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8025A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8026label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8027@var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8028may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8029systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8030bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8031bundles.
8032
8033If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8034used.
8035@end defmac
8036
8037@defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8038A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8039is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8040
8041This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8042produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8043with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8044
8045If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8046output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8047@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8048string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8049to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8050@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8051you should know what it does on your machine.)
8052@end defmac
8053
8054@defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8055A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8056@code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8057@var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8058added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8059
8060The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8061produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8062@var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8063assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8064macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8065internal static variables in different scopes.
8066
8067Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8068conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8069or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8070between the name and the number will suffice.
8071
8072If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8073which is correct for most systems.
8074@end defmac
8075
8076@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8077A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8078which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8079
8080@findex SET_ASM_OP
8081If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8082correct for most systems.
8083@end defmac
8084
8085@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8086A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8087which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8088to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8089be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8090the tree nodes are available.
8091
8092@findex SET_ASM_OP
8093If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8094correct for most systems.
8095@end defmac
8096
8097@defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8098A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8099(equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8100of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8101current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8102This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8103@samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8104@end defmac
8105
8106@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8107A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8108which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8109@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8110an undefined weak symbol.
8111
8112Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8113@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8114@end defmac
8115
8116@defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8117Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8118Objective-C methods.
8119
8120The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8121class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8122the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8123@samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8124
8125These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8126the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8127systems define other ways of computing names.
8128
8129@var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8130buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8131@var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
813250 characters extra.
8133
8134The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8135method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8136@var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8137in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8138
8139On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8140macro to provide more human-readable names.
8141@end defmac
8142
38f8b050
JR
8143@node Initialization
8144@subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8145@cindex initialization routines
8146@cindex termination routines
8147@cindex constructors, output of
8148@cindex destructors, output of
8149
8150The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8151(also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8152data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8153to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8154@code{main} is called.
8155
8156Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8157@dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8158terminates.
8159
8160To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8161must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8162be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8163system, you need to specify how to do this.
8164
8165There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8166initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8167Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8168
8169@findex __CTOR_LIST__
8170@findex __DTOR_LIST__
8171The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8172initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8173termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8174
8175Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
81760, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8177the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8178pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8179pointer containing zero.
8180
8181Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8182@file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8183time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8184list; destructors in forward order.
8185
8186The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8187formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8188aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8189Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8190object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8191the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8192accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8193Termination functions are handled similarly.
8194
8195This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8196@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8197support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8198constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8199and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8200
8201When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8202upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8203support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8204parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8205program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8206
8207@smallexample
8208ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8209@end smallexample
8210
8211The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8212section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8213for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8214files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8215are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8216
8217The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8218compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8219fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8220to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8221of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8222that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8223
8224To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8225macro properly.
8226
8227If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8228@code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8229entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8230it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8231after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8232in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8233
8234In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8235two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8236and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8237@code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8238entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8239and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8240code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8241the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8242placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8243a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8244@code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8245section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8246the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8247the initialization process.
8248
8249The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8250This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8251file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8252this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8253termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8254an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8255pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8256the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8257initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8258via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8259@code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8260
8261@ifinfo
8262The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8263customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8264@end ifinfo
8265
8266@node Macros for Initialization
8267@subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8268
8269Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8270and termination functions:
8271
8272@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8273If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8274operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8275defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8276using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8277macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8278run the initialization functions.
8279@end defmac
8280
8281@defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8282If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8283This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8284on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8285be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8286@end defmac
8287
8288@defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8289If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8290the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8291@end defmac
8292
8293@defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8294If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8295the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8296@end defmac
8297
8298@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8299If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8300automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8301should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8302the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8303function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8304
8305This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8306shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8307exception tables embedded in the code.
8308@end defmac
8309
8310@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8311If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8312automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8313should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8314the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8315function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8316@end defmac
8317
8318@defmac INVOKE__main
8319If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8320@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8321where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8322useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8323@end defmac
8324
8325@defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8326If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8327compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8328of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8329encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8330@end defmac
8331
8332@hook TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8333This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8334collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8335It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8336@end deftypevr
8337
8338@hook TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR
8339If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8340the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8341
8342Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8343no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8344priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8345otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8346
8347If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8348be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8349target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8350is not defined.
8351@end deftypefn
8352
8353@hook TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR
8354This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8355functions rather than initialization functions.
8356@end deftypefn
8357
8358If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8359generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8360
8361If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8362constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8363an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8364
8365On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8366@command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8367
8368@defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8369Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8370object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8371object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8372
8373This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8374part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8375@end defmac
8376
8377@defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8378Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8379to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8380@command{nm}.
3e794bfe
RO
8381@end defmac
8382
8383@defmac NM_FLAGS
8384@command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8385constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
8386passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
2b0d3573 8387are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
3e794bfe
RO
8388produces.
8389@end defmac
38f8b050
JR
8390
8391If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8392dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8393these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8394termination functions in shared libraries:
38f8b050
JR
8395
8396@defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8397Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
3e794bfe 8398which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
38f8b050
JR
8399@end defmac
8400
8401@defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8402Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8403of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8404of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8405from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8406code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8407line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8408@end defmac
8409
8410@defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8411Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8412library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8413strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8414constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8415that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8416@end defmac
8417
8418@node Instruction Output
8419@subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8420
8421@c prevent bad page break with this line
8422This describes assembler instruction output.
8423
8424@defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8425A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8426registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8427register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8428@end defmac
8429
8430@defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8431If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8432and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8433registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8434to registers using alternate names.
8435@end defmac
8436
0c6d290e
RE
8437@defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8438If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8439name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8440machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
8441names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8442declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
8443@code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8444register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8445
8446This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8447@code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8448register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8449VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8450``s0'' and ``s1''.
8451@end defmac
8452
38f8b050
JR
8453@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8454Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8455requires different names for the machine instructions.
8456
8457The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8458assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8459macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8460points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8461written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8462opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8463increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8464so that it will not be output twice.
8465
8466In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8467name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8468that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8469care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8470@var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8471
8472@findex recog_data.operand
8473If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8474elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8475
8476If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8477in the usual way.
8478@end defmac
8479
8480@defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8481If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8482assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8483they will be output differently.
8484
8485Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8486extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8487elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8488The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8489template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8490by changing the contents of the vector.
8491
8492This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8493file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8494can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8495as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8496syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8497writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8498
8499If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8500@end defmac
8501
8502@hook TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN
8503If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8504output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8505if necessary.
8506
8507Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8508extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8509elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8510The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8511template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8512by checking the contents of the vector.
8513@end deftypefn
8514
8515@defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8516A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8517assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8518RTL expression.
8519
8520@var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8521of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8522printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8523the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8524operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8525@var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8526@var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8527
8528@findex reg_names
8529If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8530The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8531@code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8532@code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8533
8534When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8535(a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8536with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8537@var{code}.
8538@end defmac
8539
8540@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8541A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8542punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8543@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8544punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8545in this way.
8546@end defmac
8547
8548@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8549A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8550assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8551whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8552
8553@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8554On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8555section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8556@code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8557@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8558Format}.
8559@end defmac
8560
8561@findex dbr_sequence_length
8562@defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8563A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8564been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8565determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8566currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8567or whatever.
8568
8569Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8570reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8571explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8572@end defmac
8573
8574@findex final_sequence
8575Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8576prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8577(i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8578found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8579processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8580being output.
8581
8582@findex asm_fprintf
8583@defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8584@defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8585@defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8586@defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
8587If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8588@samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8589@file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8590support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8591files can define these macros differently.
8592@end defmac
8593
8594@defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
8595If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
8596statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8597the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8598printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
8599statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
8600generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8601specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8602The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8603string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8604upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
8605@end defmac
8606
8607@defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
8608If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8609different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8610numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8611first variant.
8612
8613If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
8614@smallexample
8615@samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
8616@end smallexample
8617@noindent
8618in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8619first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8620@samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8621@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8622within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8623alternatives within the braces than the value of
8624@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
8625
8626If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8627@samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8628operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8629
8630Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8631@code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
8632the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
8633@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8634if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8635opcodes or operand order.
8636@end defmac
8637
8638@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8639A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8640which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8641The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8642profiling.
8643@end defmac
8644
8645@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8646A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8647which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8648The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8649profiling.
8650@end defmac
8651
8652@node Dispatch Tables
8653@subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8654
8655@c prevent bad page break with this line
8656This concerns dispatch tables.
8657
8658@cindex dispatch table
8659@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
8660A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8661pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8662@var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8663definitions of these labels are output using
8664@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
8665way here. For example,
8666
8667@smallexample
8668fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8669 @var{value}, @var{rel})
8670@end smallexample
8671
8672You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
8673dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
8674will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
8675@var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
8676mode and flags can be read.
8677@end defmac
8678
8679@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
8680This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8681in a dispatch table are absolute.
8682
8683The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8684@var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8685a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
8686definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8687For example,
8688
8689@smallexample
8690fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
8691@end smallexample
8692@end defmac
8693
8694@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8695Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8696specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
8697@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
8698jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
8699@code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8700
8701This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8702for the table.
8703
8704If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
8705@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8706@end defmac
8707
8708@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8709Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8710jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8711after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8712the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8713@var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8714of the preceding label.
8715
8716If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8717the jump-table.
8718@end defmac
8719
8720@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL
8721This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
8722should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8723should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8724function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
8725The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8726exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8727true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
8728
8729The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8730@end deftypefn
8731
8732@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL
8733This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8734It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8735to be broken up according to function.
8736
8737The default is that no label is emitted.
8738@end deftypefn
8739
a68b5e52
RH
8740@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY
8741
38f8b050
JR
8742@hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT
8743This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
f0a0390e
RH
8744given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8745returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
38f8b050
JR
8746@end deftypefn
8747
3bc6b3e6
RH
8748@hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8749
38f8b050
JR
8750@node Exception Region Output
8751@subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8752
8753@c prevent bad page break with this line
8754
8755This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8756region.
8757
8758@defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
8759If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8760exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
8761provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8762@file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
8763
8764You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8765unwind information and the default definition does not work.
8766@end defmac
8767
8768@defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
8769If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8770data section even though the target supports named sections. This
8771might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8772collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8773
8774Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8775also defined.
8776@end defmac
8777
8778@defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8779Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8780information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8781runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8782and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8783@end defmac
8784
8785@defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
8786An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
8787that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
8788@end defmac
8789
8790@defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
8791Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8792information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8793Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
01a07a64
SB
8794@code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}),
8795GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
f0a0390e 8796@end defmac
38f8b050 8797
f0a0390e
RH
8798@hook TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO
8799This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8800by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8801should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
8802@code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8803should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8804information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
38f8b050 8805
f0a0390e
RH
8806A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8807This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
8808default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
38f8b050 8809
f0a0390e 8810Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
d5fabb58
JM
8811not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
8812@var{opts}. In particular, the
f0a0390e
RH
8813setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
8814macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
8815depending on this setting.
8816
8817The default implementation of the hook first honors the
8818@option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
d5fabb58
JM
8819@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
8820@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
8821must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
f0a0390e 8822@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8823
8824@hook TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
8825This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
d5fabb58
JM
8826tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
8827command-line option processing.
38f8b050
JR
8828@end deftypevr
8829
38f8b050
JR
8830@defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
8831Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
8832should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
8833instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
8834@end defmac
8835
39ce30d8
SB
8836@defmac JMP_BUF_SIZE
8837This macro has no effect unless @code{DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP} is also
8838defined. Define this macro if the default size of @code{jmp_buf} buffer
8839for the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism
8840is not large enough, or if it is much too large.
8841The default size is @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER * sizeof(void *)}.
8842@end defmac
8843
38f8b050
JR
8844@defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
8845This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
8846function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
8847@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
8848alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
8849minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
8850the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
8851@end defmac
8852
8853@hook TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
8854Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
8855end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
8856Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
8857true otherwise.
8858@end deftypevr
8859
8860@hook TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN
8861Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
8862represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
8863register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
8864locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
8865register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8866If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8867@end deftypefn
8868
8869@hook TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA
8870If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
8871multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
8872sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
8873It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
8874filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
8875@var{address} is the address of the table.
8876@end deftypefn
8877
8878@hook TARGET_ASM_TTYPE
8879This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
8880the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
8881if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
8882reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
8883@end deftypefn
8884
8885@hook TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
8886This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
8887based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
8888the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
8889running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
8890@end deftypevr
8891
8892@node Alignment Output
8893@subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
8894
8895@c prevent bad page break with this line
8896This describes commands for alignment.
8897
8898@defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8899The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
8900a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
8901
8902This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8903to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8904define the macro.
8905
8906Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8907to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
8908@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8909selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
8910@end defmac
8911
ad0c4c36
DD
8912@hook TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8913The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
8914@code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
8915@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8916@end deftypefn
8917
38f8b050
JR
8918@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
8919The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8920a @code{BARRIER}.
8921
8922This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8923to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8924define the macro.
8925@end defmac
8926
ad0c4c36
DD
8927@hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
8928The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
38f8b050
JR
8929@code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
8930@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
ad0c4c36 8931@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8932
8933@defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8934The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8935a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
8936
8937This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8938to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8939define the macro.
8940
8941Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8942to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
8943@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8944selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
8945@end defmac
8946
ad0c4c36
DD
8947@hook TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8948The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
8949@var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
8950defined.
8951@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8952
8953@defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
8954The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
8955If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
8956the maximum of the specified values is used.
8957
8958Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8959to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
8960@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8961selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
8962@end defmac
8963
ad0c4c36
DD
8964@hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8965The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
8966to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
8967is defined.
8968@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8969
8970@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
8971A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8972instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
8973Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
8974expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
8975@end defmac
8976
8977@defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
8978Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
8979text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
8980This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
8981produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
8982section.
8983@end defmac
8984
8985@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8986A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8987command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
8988@var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
8989@end defmac
8990
8991@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8992Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
8993for padding, if necessary.
8994@end defmac
8995
8996@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
8997A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8998command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
8999@var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9000satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9001a C expression of type @code{int}.
9002@end defmac
9003
9004@need 3000
9005@node Debugging Info
9006@section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9007
9008@c prevent bad page break with this line
9009This describes how to specify debugging information.
9010
9011@menu
9012* All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9013* DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9014* DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9015* File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9016* SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
9017* VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
9018@end menu
9019
9020@node All Debuggers
9021@subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9022
9023@c prevent bad page break with this line
9024These macros affect all debugging formats.
9025
9026@defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9027A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9028register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9029of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9030some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9031versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9032compiler and another for DBX@.
9033
9034If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9035used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9036consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9037Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9038expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9039
9040If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9041does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9042redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9043@end defmac
9044
9045@defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9046A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9047variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9048computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9049gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9050that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9051for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9052@option{-g} options is used.
9053@end defmac
9054
9055@defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9056A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9057having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9058@var{offset}.
9059@end defmac
9060
9061@defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9062A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9063produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9064this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9065debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9066@code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9067@code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9068
9069When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9070value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9071exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9072value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9073defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9074
9075The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9076user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9077@option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9078@end defmac
9079
9080@node DBX Options
9081@subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9082
9083@c prevent bad page break with this line
9084These are specific options for DBX output.
9085
9086@defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9087Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9088in response to the @option{-g} option.
9089@end defmac
9090
9091@defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9092Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9093in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9094@end defmac
9095
9096@defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9097Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9098GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9099debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9100macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9101if there is any occasion to.
9102@end defmac
9103
9104@defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9105Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9106in the text section.
9107@end defmac
9108
9109@defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9110A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9111use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9112If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9113applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9114@end defmac
9115
9116@defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9117A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9118use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9119value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9120@code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9121information format.
9122@end defmac
9123
9124@defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9125A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9126use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9127name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9128macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9129@end defmac
9130
9131@defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9132Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9133@samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9134describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9135On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9136@end defmac
9137
9138@defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9139A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9140continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9141exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9142operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9143must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9144with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9145defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9146@end defmac
9147
9148@defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9149Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9150the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9151a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9152constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9153if backslash is correct for your system.
9154@end defmac
9155
9156@defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9157Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9158outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9159variable.
9160@end defmac
9161
9162@defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9163The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9164for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9165@end defmac
9166
9167@defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9168The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9169for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9170provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9171@end defmac
9172
9173@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9174The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9175for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9176``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9177@end defmac
9178
9179@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9180The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9181passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9182do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9183@end defmac
9184
9185@defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9186Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9187arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9188in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9189code.
9190@end defmac
9191
9192@defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9193Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9194the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9195relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9196an absolute address.
9197@end defmac
9198
9199@defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9200Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9201the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9202start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9203@end defmac
9204
9205@defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9206Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9207@code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9208macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9209number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9210generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9211number for a type number.
9212@end defmac
9213
9214@node DBX Hooks
9215@subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9216
9217@c prevent bad page break with this line
9218These are hooks for DBX format.
9219
38f8b050
JR
9220@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9221A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9222number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9223@var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9224invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9225unique labels in the assembly output.
9226
9227This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9228if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9229@end defmac
9230
9231@defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9232Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9233@code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9234On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9235disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9236@end defmac
9237
9238@defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9239Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9240extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9241feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9242@end defmac
9243
9244@node File Names and DBX
9245@subsection File Names in DBX Format
9246
9247@c prevent bad page break with this line
9248This describes file names in DBX format.
9249
9250@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9251A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9252@var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9253file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9254This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9255
9256This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9257for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9258
9259It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9260text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9261to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9262@var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9263@end defmac
9264
9265@defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9266Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9267of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9268the beginning of the file.
9269@end defmac
9270
9271@defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9272Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9273that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9274an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9275@samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9276@end defmac
9277
9278@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9279A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9280compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9281written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9282
9283If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9284of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9285@end defmac
9286
9287@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9288Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9289@code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9290the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9291whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9292@end defmac
9293
9294@need 2000
9295@node SDB and DWARF
9296@subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9297
9298@c prevent bad page break with this line
9299Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9300
9301@defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9302Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9303for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9304@end defmac
9305
9306@defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9307Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9308debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9309
9310@hook TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION
9311Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9312be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9313value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9314@end deftypefn
9315
9316To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9317define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9318@code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9319prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9320as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9321@end defmac
9322
9323@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9324Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
f0a0390e
RH
9325Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9326(@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9327exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9328how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
38f8b050
JR
9329@end defmac
9330
f0a0390e
RH
9331@hook TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO
9332This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9333unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9334@code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9335return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9336
9337A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9338is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9339
9340A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9341This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9342@end deftypefn
9343
38f8b050
JR
9344@defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9345Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9346line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9347tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9348@end defmac
9349
9730bc27
TT
9350@hook TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9351
638c962f
JH
9352@hook TARGET_FORCE_AT_COMP_DIR
9353
2ba42841
AO
9354@hook TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
9355
9356@hook TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
9357
38f8b050
JR
9358@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9359A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9360@var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9361@end defmac
9362
9363@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9364A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9365between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9366slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9367@end defmac
9368
9369@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
9370A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9371section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9372given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
9373@end defmac
9374
9375@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9376A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9377reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9378@end defmac
9379
9380@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9381A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9382the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9383is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9384is referenced by a function.
9385@end defmac
9386
9387@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL
9388If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9389reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9390@end deftypefn
9391
9392@defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9393Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9394SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9395macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9396not define them yourself.
9397@end defmac
9398
9399@defmac SDB_DELIM
9400Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9401SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9402delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9403a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9404required.
9405@end defmac
9406
9407@defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9408Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9409union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9410allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9411it.
9412@end defmac
9413
9414@defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9415Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9416enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9417assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9418@end defmac
9419
9420@defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9421A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9422number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9423@var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9424@end defmac
9425
9426@need 2000
9427@node VMS Debug
9428@subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9429
9430@c prevent bad page break with this line
9431Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9432
9433@defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9434Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9435in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9436is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9437@option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
fac0f722 9438behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
38f8b050
JR
9439@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9440@end defmac
9441
9442@node Floating Point
9443@section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9444@cindex cross compilation and floating point
9445@cindex floating point and cross compilation
9446
9447While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9448there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9449means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9450in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9451doing the compilation.
9452
9453Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9454range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9455the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9456safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9457the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9458emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9459target floating point formats are identical.
9460
9461The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9462use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9463floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9464their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9465
9466@defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9467The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9468machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9469array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9470quantity.
9471@end defmac
9472
9473@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9474Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
9475floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9476@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9477@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9478@end deftypefn
9479
9480@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9481Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9482@end deftypefn
9483
9484@deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9485Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9486@end deftypefn
9487
9488@deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9489Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9490@var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9491@end deftypefn
9492
9493@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9494Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9495representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9496decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9497defined by the C language for both.
9498@end deftypefn
9499
9500@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9501Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9502@end deftypefn
9503
9504@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9505Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9506@end deftypefn
9507
9508@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9509Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9510@end deftypefn
9511
9512@deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9513Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9514@var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9515variable).
9516
9517The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
9518following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9519@code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9520
9521If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9522target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9523@code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
9524@code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
9525@end deftypefn
9526
9527@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9528Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9529@end deftypefn
9530
9531@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9532Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9533@end deftypefn
9534
38f8b050
JR
9535@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9536Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
9537which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
9538integral, it is truncated.
9539@end deftypefn
9540
9541@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9542Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
9543into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
9544value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
9545@end deftypefn
9546
9547@node Mode Switching
9548@section Mode Switching Instructions
9549@cindex mode switching
9550The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9551
9552@defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9553Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9554switching in an optimizing compilation.
9555
9556For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9557floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9558the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9559operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9560purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9561be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9562or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9563
9564You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9565which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9566return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9567If you define this macro, you also have to define
9568@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
9569@code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
9570@code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
9571are optional.
9572@end defmac
9573
9574@defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9575If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9576initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9577N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9578of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9579The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9580zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9581entity in question.
9582In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9583represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9584switch is needed / supplied.
9585@end defmac
9586
9587@defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
9588@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9589@code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
9590return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
9591@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
9592be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
9593@end defmac
9594
9786913b
UB
9595@defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{insn})
9596@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9597this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
38f8b050
JR
9598mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
9599different from the incoming mode).
9600@end defmac
9601
9602@defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
9603If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9604mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9605@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
9606is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9607@end defmac
9608
9609@defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
9610If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9611mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9612@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{MODE_EXIT}
9613is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9614@end defmac
9615
9616@defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
9617This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
96180 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
9619lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
9620for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
9621(@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
9622@code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9623@end defmac
9624
9625@defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
9626Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
9627@var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
9628the insn(s) are to be inserted.
9629@end defmac
9630
9631@node Target Attributes
9632@section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9633@cindex target attributes
9634@cindex machine attributes
9635@cindex attributes, target-specific
9636
9637Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9638These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9639be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9640
9641@hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9642If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9643attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
9644specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9645entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9646take.
9647@end deftypevr
9648
9649@hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P
9650If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9651machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9652given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9653subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9654false for all machine-specific attributes.
9655@end deftypefn
9656
9657@hook TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9658If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9659@var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9660and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9661generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9662supposed always to be compatible.
9663@end deftypefn
9664
9665@hook TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9666If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
9667the newly defined @var{type}.
9668@end deftypefn
9669
9670@hook TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9671Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9672handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9673@code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9674that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9675function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9676merging.
9677@end deftypefn
9678
9679@hook TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9680Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9681handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9682@code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9683@var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9684when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9685attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9686call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9687
9688@findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9689If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9690for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9691@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9692will then define a function called
9693@code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9694the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9695add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9696to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9697@samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9698@file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
9699@end deftypefn
9700
9701@hook TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P
9702
9703@defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
9704Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
9705@code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9706default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9707@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9708of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9709on this implementation detail.
9710@end defmac
9711
9712@hook TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES
9713Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9714when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9715wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9716the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9717created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9718for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9719shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9720the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9721attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9722needed.
9723@end deftypefn
9724
9725@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P
9726@cindex inlining
9727This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
9728into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9729attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9730target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9731@end deftypefn
9732
9733@hook TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P
9734This hook is called to parse the @code{attribute(option("..."))}, and
9735it allows the function to set different target machine compile time
9736options for the current function that might be different than the
9737options specified on the command line. The hook should return
9738@code{true} if the options are valid.
9739
9740The hook should set the @var{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9741the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target specific
9742@var{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9743@end deftypefn
9744
9745@hook TARGET_OPTION_SAVE
9746This hook is called to save any additional target specific information
9747in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for function specific
9748options.
9749@xref{Option file format}.
9750@end deftypefn
9751
9752@hook TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE
9753This hook is called to restore any additional target specific
9754information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9755function specific options.
9756@end deftypefn
9757
9758@hook TARGET_OPTION_PRINT
9759This hook is called to print any additional target specific
9760information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9761function specific options.
9762@end deftypefn
9763
56cb42ea 9764@hook TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE
38f8b050
JR
9765This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC option} to
9766set the machine specific options for functions that occur later in the
9767input stream. The options should be the same as handled by the
56cb42ea 9768@code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
38f8b050
JR
9769@end deftypefn
9770
9771@hook TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE
9772Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9773a particular target machine. You can override the hook
9774@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
9775once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9776
9777Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
fac0f722 9778@option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
38f8b050
JR
9779
9780If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9781changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9782@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9783@end deftypefn
9784
9785@hook TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P
9786This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9787cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
9788default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9789specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9790@end deftypefn
9791
9792@node Emulated TLS
9793@section Emulating TLS
9794@cindex Emulated TLS
9795
9796For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9797specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9798used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9799configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
9800the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
9801layer.
9802
9803The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
9804object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
9805which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
9806address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
9807
9808@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
9809Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
9810object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
9811emulated TLS helper function to be used.
9812@end deftypevr
9813
9814@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
9815Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
9816program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
9817initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
9818have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
9819registration function to be used.
9820@end deftypevr
9821
9822@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
9823Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
9824be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
9825any section.
9826@end deftypevr
9827
9828@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
9829Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
9830placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
9831section.
9832@end deftypevr
9833
9834@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
9835Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
9836The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9837@end deftypevr
9838
9839@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
9840Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
9841default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9842@end deftypevr
9843
9844@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS
9845Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
9846object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
9847@var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
9848@code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
9849for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
9850@end deftypefn
9851
9852@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT
9853Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
9854TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
9855is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
9856initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
9857@end deftypefn
9858
9859@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
9860Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
9861fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
9862single objects. The default is false.
9863@end deftypevr
9864
9865@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
9866Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
9867may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
9868@end deftypevr
9869
9870@node MIPS Coprocessors
9871@section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
9872@cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
9873
9874The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
9875coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
9876accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
9877and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
9878
9879@smallexample
9880 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
9881 unsigned int d;
9882
9883 d = cp0count + 3;
9884@end smallexample
9885
9886(``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
9887names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
9888overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
9889
9890Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
9891be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
9892later in the function.
9893
9894Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
9895the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
9896floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
9897
9898There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
9899you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
9900
38f8b050
JR
9901@node PCH Target
9902@section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
9903@cindex parameters, precompiled headers
9904
9905@hook TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY
9906This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
9907@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
9908@samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
9909@end deftypefn
9910
9911@hook TARGET_PCH_VALID_P
9912This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
9913compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
9914if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
9915be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
9916
9917@var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
9918when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
9919It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
9920compiler, so no format checking is needed.
9921
9922The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
9923suitable for most targets.
9924@end deftypefn
9925
9926@hook TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS
9927If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
9928@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
9929of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
9930@code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
9931value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
9932@end deftypefn
9933
e32ea2d1
RS
9934@hook TARGET_PREPARE_PCH_SAVE
9935
38f8b050
JR
9936@node C++ ABI
9937@section C++ ABI parameters
9938@cindex parameters, c++ abi
9939
9940@hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE
9941Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
9942These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
9943default is long_long_integer_type_node.
9944@end deftypefn
9945
9946@hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT
9947This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
9948@code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
9949@code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
9950@end deftypefn
9951
9952@hook TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE
9953This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
9954whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
9955known that a cookie is needed. The default is
9956@code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
9957IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
9958@end deftypefn
9959
9960@hook TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE
9961This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
9962array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
9963@end deftypefn
9964
9965@hook TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS
9966If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
9967class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
9968will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
9969to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
9970modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
9971backend's targeted operating system.
9972@end deftypefn
9973
9974@hook TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS
9975This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
9976the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
9977@code{false}.
9978@end deftypefn
9979
9980@hook TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE
9981This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
9982which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
9983table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
9984Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
9985the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
9986some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
9987method. The default is to return @code{true}.
9988@end deftypefn
9989
9990@hook TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY
9991
9992@hook TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT
9993This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
9994similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
9995external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
9996classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
9997unit will not be COMDAT.
9998@end deftypefn
9999
10000@hook TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT
10001This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10002the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10003be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10004@end deftypefn
10005
10006@hook TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT
10007This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10008should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10009is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10010@end deftypefn
10011
10012@hook TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT
10013This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10014in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10015destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10016shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10017unloaded. The default is to return false.
10018@end deftypefn
10019
10020@hook TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION
10021
17c4f786
AS
10022@hook TARGET_CXX_DECL_MANGLING_CONTEXT
10023
38f8b050
JR
10024@node Named Address Spaces
10025@section Adding support for named address spaces
10026@cindex named address spaces
10027
10028The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10029standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10030support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10031processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10032GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10033address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10034spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10035@code{const} type attributes.
10036
10037Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10038pointers to the generic address space.
10039
10040For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10041to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10042processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10043issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10044local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10045address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10046@option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10047always 32 bits).
10048
10049Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10050range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10051address space.
10052
10053To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10054the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10055the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10056named address space #1:
10057@smallexample
10058#define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10059c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10060@end smallexample
10061
10062@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE
10063Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10064@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10065The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10066generic address space only.
10067@end deftypefn
10068
10069@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE
10070Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10071@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10072The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10073generic address space only.
10074@end deftypefn
10075
10076@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE
10077Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10078with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10079hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10080except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10081version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10082@code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10083target hooks for the given address space.
10084@end deftypefn
10085
10086@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
10087Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10088@var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10089parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10090finished. This target hook is the same as the
10091@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10092explicit named address space support.
10093@end deftypefn
10094
10095@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
10096Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10097with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10098hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10099except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10100@end deftypefn
10101
10102@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P
10103Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10104contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10105a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10106will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10107arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10108converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10109@end deftypefn
10110
10111@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT
10112Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10113@var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10114space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10115to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10116guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10117as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10118@end deftypefn
10119
10120@node Misc
10121@section Miscellaneous Parameters
10122@cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10123
10124@c prevent bad page break with this line
10125Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10126
10127@defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10128Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10129has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10130conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10131blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10132set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10133to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10134@end defmac
10135
10136@defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10137Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10138has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10139conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10140blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10141set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10142to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10143@end defmac
10144
10145@defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10146An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10147elements of a jump-table should have.
10148@end defmac
10149
10150@defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10151Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10152when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10153it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10154To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10155make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10156The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10157flags can be updated.
10158@end defmac
10159
10160@defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10161Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10162should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10163jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10164contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10165is in effect.
10166@end defmac
10167
10168@hook TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
10169This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10170is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10171The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10172five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10173@end deftypefn
10174
38f8b050
JR
10175@defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10176Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10177smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10178Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10179@end defmac
10180
10181@defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10182Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10183memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10184bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10185zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10186of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10187insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10188@code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10189
10190This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10191greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10192value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10193@code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10194define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10195
10196You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10197the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10198of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10199when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10200integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10201
10202You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10203mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10204@code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10205is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10206@end defmac
10207
10208@defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10209Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10210extends.
10211@end defmac
10212
38f8b050
JR
10213@hook TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL
10214When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10215divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10216the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10217that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10218of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10219has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10220@end deftypefn
10221
10222@defmac MOVE_MAX
10223The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10224between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10225@end defmac
10226
10227@defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10228The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10229between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10230is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10231constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10232at run-time.
10233@end defmac
10234
10235@defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10236A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10237actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10238of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10239this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10240a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10241truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10242instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10243include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10244also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10245arguments to bit-field instructions.
10246
10247If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10248position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10249instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10250
10251However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10252only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10253bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10254such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10255the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10256
10257You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10258@end defmac
10259
10260@anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10261@hook TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK
10262This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10263deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10264@xref{shift patterns}.
10265
10266On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10267shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10268equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10269this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10270otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10271particular behavior is guaranteed.
10272
10273Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10274@emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10275that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10276
10277The default implementation of this function returns
10278@code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10279and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10280@code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10281nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10282by overriding it.
10283@end deftypefn
10284
10285@defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10286A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10287``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10288bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10289operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10290
10291On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10292
10293@c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10294@c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10295When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10296modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10297If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10298such cases may improve things.
10299@end defmac
10300
10301@hook TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED
10302The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10303are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10304@code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10305sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10306otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10307representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10308@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10309@code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10310@var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10311widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10312
10313Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10314value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10315as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10316@code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10317
10318Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10319describe two related properties. If you define
10320@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10321to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10322extension.
10323
10324In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10325@code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10326@code{mode}.
10327@end deftypefn
10328
10329@defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10330A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10331with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10332(@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10333apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10334comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10335
10336A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10337comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10338and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10339which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10340true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10341operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10342@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10343@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10344the compiler.
10345
10346If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10347generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10348replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10349the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10350For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10351@code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10352@samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10353expression
10354
10355@smallexample
10356(ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10357@end smallexample
10358
10359@noindent
10360can be converted to
10361
10362@smallexample
10363(ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10364@end smallexample
10365
10366@noindent
10367where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10368tested into the sign bit.
10369
10370There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10371for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10372but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10373are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10374perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10375comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10376
10377Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10378from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10379choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10380to be used:
10381
10382@itemize @bullet
10383@item
10384Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10385@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10386``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10387comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10388combine the normalization with other operations.
10389
10390@item
10391For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10392slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10393other machines.
10394
10395@item
10396As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10397exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10398others.
10399
10400@item
10401Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10402@end itemize
10403
10404Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10405@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10406instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10407those cases, e.g., one matching
10408
10409@smallexample
10410(set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10411@end smallexample
10412
10413Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10414condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10415@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10416machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10417and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10418@code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
2b0d3573 10419@file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
38f8b050
JR
10420find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10421
10422If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10423not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10424instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10425@end defmac
10426
10427@defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10428A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10429returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10430Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10431floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10432this macro.
10433@end defmac
10434
10435@defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10436A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10437for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10438mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10439this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10440return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10441this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10442@code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10443the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10444given mode.
10445@end defmac
10446
10447@defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10448@defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10449A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
ff2ce160 10450for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
38f8b050
JR
10451A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10452If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10453evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10454entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
ff2ce160 10455the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
38f8b050 10456In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
ff2ce160 10457this value.
38f8b050
JR
10458
10459If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10460@code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10461
10462This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10463relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10464is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10465to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10466
10467Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10468and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10469visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10470to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10471breaking the API@.
10472@end defmac
10473
10474@defmac Pmode
10475An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10476this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10477pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10478On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10479modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10480
10481The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10482@code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10483@code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10484to @code{Pmode}.
10485@end defmac
10486
10487@defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10488An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10489being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
ff2ce160 10490where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
38f8b050
JR
10491@code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10492size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10493as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10494@end defmac
10495
10496@defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10497In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10498constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10499hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10500where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10501strict conformance to the C Standard.
10502
10503Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10504convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10505files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10506@end defmac
10507
10508@defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10509Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10510This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10511C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10512@samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10513@end defmac
10514
10515@findex #pragma
10516@findex pragma
10517@defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10518Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10519If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10520@code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10521for each pragma. The macro may also do any
10522setup required for the pragmas.
10523
10524The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10525other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
10526definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10527
10528If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10529defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10530
10531Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10532@samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10533silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10534@end defmac
10535
10536@deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10537@deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10538
10539Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10540@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
10541@var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10542pragma of the form
10543
10544@smallexample
10545#pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10546@end smallexample
10547
10548@var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10549@code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10550routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10551on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
10552@var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
10553callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
10554a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10555arguments of pragmas registered with
10556@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10557pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
10558
10559Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
10560compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
10561other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
10562to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
10563building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
10564variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
10565target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
10566the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
10567code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
10568rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10569how to build this object file.
10570@end deftypefun
10571
38f8b050 10572@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
24a57808 10573Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
38f8b050
JR
10574arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10575@end defmac
10576
38f8b050
JR
10577@defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10578If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
10579the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
10580This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
10581@samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10582@end defmac
10583
10584@defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
10585Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
10586identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
10587not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10588there is no need to define this macro in that case.
10589@end defmac
10590
38f8b050
JR
10591@defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10592Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10593delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10594even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
10595@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
10596every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10597or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10598you should define this macro.
10599
10600You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10601@end defmac
10602
10603@defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10604Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10605delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10606even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10607@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10608some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10609are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10610define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10611instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10612slot of @var{insn}.
10613
10614You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10615@end defmac
10616
10617@defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
10618Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10619global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10620symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10621instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10622from shared libraries (DLLs).
10623
10624You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
10625@end defmac
10626
10627@hook TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS
10628This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
10629any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
10630It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
10631clobber. The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
10632corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
10633clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm. You can use
10634@code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
10635for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
10636@end deftypefn
10637
10638@defmac MATH_LIBRARY
10639Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
d9d16a19
JM
10640in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10641@samp{""} if the target does not have a
38f8b050
JR
10642separate math library.
10643
d9d16a19 10644You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
38f8b050
JR
10645@end defmac
10646
10647@defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
10648Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10649specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10650
10651You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10652is wrong.
10653@end defmac
10654
10655@defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10656Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10657functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10658Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
10659to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
10660if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
10661for cross-profiling.
10662@end defmac
10663
10664@defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
10665
10666A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10667conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10668@code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
106691 if it does use cc0.
10670@end defmac
10671
10672@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10673Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10674conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10675@var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10676contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10677and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10678then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10679@var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
10680@end defmac
10681
10682@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10683Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10684if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10685@var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10686being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
10687@end defmac
10688
10689@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
10690A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10691be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10692a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10693about the currently processed blocks.
10694@end defmac
10695
10696@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
10697A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
10698converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10699can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10700to by @var{ce_info}.
10701@end defmac
10702
10703@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
10704A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
10705converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10706can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10707to by @var{ce_info}.
10708@end defmac
10709
67a0732f
SB
10710@defmac IFCVT_MACHDEP_INIT (@var{ce_info})
10711A C expression to initialize any machine specific data for if-conversion
10712of the if-block in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10713to by @var{ce_info}.
38f8b050
JR
10714@end defmac
10715
10716@hook TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
10717If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10718instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10719just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10720
10721The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
10722it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10723laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10724Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10725
10726You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
10727definition is null.
10728@end deftypefn
10729
10730@hook TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS
10731Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10732that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
10733necessary setup.
10734
10735Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
10736instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10737they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10738instructions or prefetch instructions).
10739
10740To create a built-in function, call the function
10741@code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
10742which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
1a072294 10743up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes};
38f8b050
JR
10744only language front ends that use those two functions will call
10745@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
10746@end deftypefn
10747
10748@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL
10749Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10750that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
10751builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10752If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10753if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10754If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10755@code{error_mark_node}.
10756@end deftypefn
10757
10758@hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN
10759
10760Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10761@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
10762function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10763convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10764@var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10765@var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10766ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
10767built-in function.
10768@end deftypefn
10769
d66f5459 10770@hook TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN
38f8b050
JR
10771Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
10772was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
10773@emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
10774implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
10775declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
10776arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
10777complete expression that implements the operation, usually
10778another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
10779@var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
10780@end deftypefn
10781
08914aaa 10782@hook TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN
38f8b050
JR
10783Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10784@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
10785built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
10786the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
10787The result is another tree containing a simplified expression for the
10788call's result. If @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
10789@end deftypefn
10790
10791@hook TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP
10792
10793Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
10794low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
10795could not be applied.
10796
10797Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
10798instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
10799the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
10800By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
10801loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
10802@end deftypefn
10803
78e4f1ad
UB
10804@hook TARGET_LEGITIMATE_COMBINED_INSN
10805
38f8b050
JR
10806@defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
10807
10808Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
10809Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
10810@var{branch2} is possible.
10811
10812On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
10813filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
10814may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
10815@end defmac
10816
4b4de898
JR
10817@hook TARGET_CAN_FOLLOW_JUMP
10818
38f8b050
JR
10819@hook TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P
10820This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
10821Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
10822PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
10823of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
10824@end deftypefn
10825
10826@hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE
10827
10828When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
10829register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
10830to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
10831it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
10832is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
10833that had its initial value copied by using
10834@code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
10835Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
10836to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
10837the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
10838@code{MEM}.
10839If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
10840it might decide to use another register anyways.
29454ff5
SL
10841You may use @code{current_function_is_leaf} or
10842@code{REG_N_SETS} in the hook to determine if the hard
38f8b050
JR
10843register in question will not be clobbered.
10844The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
10845allocation.
10846@end deftypefn
10847
10848@hook TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P
10849This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
10850@code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
10851this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
10852@code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
10853to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
10854passed along.
10855@end deftypefn
10856
10857@hook TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION
ff2ce160 10858The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
38f8b050
JR
10859context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
10860the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
10861per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
10862attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
10863The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
10864and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
10865and is returning to processing at the top level.
10866The default hook function does nothing.
10867
10868GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
10869some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
10870situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
10871or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
10872@code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
10873outside of any function scope.
10874@end deftypefn
10875
10876@defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
10877Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
10878files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
10879use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
10880@end defmac
10881
10882@defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
10883Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
10884automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
10885do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
10886executable files.
10887@end defmac
10888
10889@defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
10890If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
10891specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
10892Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
10893object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
10894lists.
10895@end defmac
10896
10897@defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
10898Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
10899method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
10900must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
10901For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
10902the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
10903defined as this expression:
10904
10905@smallexample
10906build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
10907 build_tree_list
10908 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
10909 NULL))
10910@end smallexample
10911@end defmac
10912
10913@hook TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P
10914This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
10915instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
10916every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
10917reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
10918
10919@smallexample
10920static bool
10921cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
10922@{
10923 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
10924@}
10925@end smallexample
10926@end deftypefn
10927
10928@hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS
10929This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
10930optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
10931usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
10932re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
10933to inter-block scheduling.
10934@end deftypefn
10935
10936@hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED
10937Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
10938registers
10939that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
10940returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
10941that all target registers in the class returned by
10942@samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
10943saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
10944epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
10945true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
10946to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
10947to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
10948@end deftypefn
10949
10950@hook TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION
10951This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
10952This target hook is required only when the target has several different
10953modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
10954@end deftypefn
10955
10956@hook TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST
10957This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
10958should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
10959the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
10960the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
10961is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
10962number of memory accesses.
10963@end deftypefn
10964
10965@defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
10966If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
10967that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
10968that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
10969constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
10970more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
10971system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
10972The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
10973@end defmac
10974
10975@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
10976This target hook should register any extra include files for the
10977target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
10978are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
10979The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
10980@end deftypefn
10981
10982@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
10983This target hook should register any extra include files for the
10984target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
10985indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
10986@var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
10987@var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
10988@end deftypefn
10989
10990@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
10991This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
10992The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
10993systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
10994that are different from @option{-I}.
10995@end deftypefn
10996
10997@defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
10998This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
10999for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11000@code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11001functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11002@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11003@end defmac
11004
11005@defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11006If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11007target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11008option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11009@end defmac
11010
11011@defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11012If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11013@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11014@end defmac
11015
11016@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11017If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11018target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11019default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11020@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11021@end defmac
11022
11023@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11024If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11025@code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11026@end defmac
11027
11028@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11029If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11030routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11031and scanf formatter settings.
11032@end defmac
11033
11034@hook TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
11035If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
11036guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
11037main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
11038important, an explicit memory barrier must be used. This is true of
11039many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
11040``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
11041and ia64. The default is @code{false}.
11042@end deftypevr
11043
11044@hook TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN
11045If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11046illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11047with prototype @var{typelist}.
11048@end deftypefn
11049
11050@hook TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION
11051If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11052invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11053if validity should be determined by the front end.
11054@end deftypefn
11055
11056@hook TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP
11057If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11058invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11059@code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11060if validity should be determined by the front end.
11061@end deftypefn
11062
11063@hook TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP
11064If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11065invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11066and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11067the front end.
11068@end deftypefn
11069
11070@hook TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE
11071If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
ff2ce160 11072invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
38f8b050
JR
11073or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11074the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11075@end deftypefn
11076
11077@hook TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE
11078If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
ff2ce160 11079invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
38f8b050
JR
11080or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11081the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11082@end deftypefn
11083
11084@hook TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE
ff2ce160
MS
11085If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11086@var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
38f8b050
JR
11087analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11088front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11089target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11090This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11091@end deftypefn
11092
11093@hook TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE
ff2ce160
MS
11094If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11095@var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
38f8b050 11096or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
ff2ce160 11097This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
38f8b050
JR
11098conversion rules.
11099This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11100@end deftypefn
11101
11102@defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11103This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11104classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11105SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11106@end defmac
11107
11108@defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11109This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11110NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11111@end defmac
11112
11113@defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11114Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
ff2ce160 11115to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
38f8b050
JR
11116call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11117and the associated definitions of those functions.
11118@end defmac
11119
11120@hook TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY
11121Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11122necessary.
11123@end deftypefn
11124
11125@hook TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX
11126This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11127different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11128argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11129is needed.
11130@end deftypefn
11131
11132@hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS
11133When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11134arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11135stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11136debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11137@code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11138cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11139to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11140false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11141@end deftypefn
11142
11143@hook TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11144On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11145a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11146is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11147is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11148subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11149the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11150available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11151constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11152down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11153@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11154accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11155value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11156MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11157@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11158is zero, which disables this optimization. @end deftypevr
57c5ab1b 11159
5dcfdccd
KY
11160@hook TARGET_MEMMODEL_CHECK
11161Validate target specific memory model mask bits. When NULL no target specific
11162memory model bits are allowed.
11163@end deftypefn
11164
57c5ab1b 11165@hook TARGET_ATOMIC_TEST_AND_SET_TRUEVAL